blob: a2ba7cf934c174f2875278c4fc3d879706f71aed [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaudc0936c2020-06-19 21:43:26 +02007 2020/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200606 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100609 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100611 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200612 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200614 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200617 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - presetenv
619 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 - uid
621 - ulimit-n
622 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200623 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100624 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200625 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200628 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-bind-options
630 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200631 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - ssl-default-server-options
633 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100634 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200635 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100636 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100637 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100638 - 51degrees-data-file
639 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200640 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200641 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-data-file
643 - wurfl-information-list
644 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200645 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100646 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100649 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200650 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200652 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100653 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100654 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100655 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200656 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200657 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200658 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200659 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - noepoll
661 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000662 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200663 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100664 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300665 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000666 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100667 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200668 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200669 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200670 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000671 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000672 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200673 - tune.buffers.limit
674 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200675 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200676 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100677 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200678 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200679 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200680 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200681 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100682 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200683 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200684 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100685 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100687 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100688 - tune.lua.session-timeout
689 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200690 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100691 - tune.maxaccept
692 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200693 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200694 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200695 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.rcvbuf.client
697 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100698 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200699 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100700 - tune.sndbuf.client
701 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100702 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100703 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200704 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100705 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200706 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200707 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100708 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200709 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100710 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200711 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
712 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
713 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100714 - tune.zlib.memlevel
715 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717 * Debugging
718 - debug
719 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200720 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721
722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007233.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724------------------------------------
725
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200726ca-base <dir>
727 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100728 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
729 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
730 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200731
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200732chroot <jail dir>
733 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
734 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
735 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
736 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
737 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100738 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100739
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
741 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
742 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
743 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
744 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
745 set. These sets have the format
746
747 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
748
749 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100751 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
752 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100753 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
754 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100755 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100756 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100757 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100758 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
760 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
761 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
762 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100763
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100764 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
765 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
766 on the machine's word size.
767
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100768 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100769 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
770 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
771 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
772 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
773 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
774 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100775
776 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
778
779 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
780 # first 4 CPUs
781
782 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
783 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
784 # word size.
785
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100786 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100787 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
790 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
791
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100792 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
793 # and so on.
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
797
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100798 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100799 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
800 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
801 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
802
803 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
804 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
805 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
806
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100807 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
808 # and a thread range.
809 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
810 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
811 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
812
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200813crt-base <dir>
814 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100815 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
816 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818daemon
819 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
820 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100821 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
822 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824deviceatlas-json-file <path>
825 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827
828deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200830 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
831
832deviceatlas-separator <char>
833 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
834 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
835
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100836deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200837 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
838 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
839 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100840
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900841external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100842 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
843 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100844 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
845 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
846 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
847 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
848 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850gid <number>
851 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
852 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
853 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100854 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
855 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100857
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100858group <group name>
859 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
860 See also "gid" and "user".
861
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100862hard-stop-after <time>
863 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
864
865 Arguments :
866 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
867 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
868 SIGUSR1 signal.
869
870 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
871 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
872 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
873
874 Example:
875 global
876 hard-stop-after 30s
877
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200878h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
879 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
880 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
881 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
882 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500883 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200884 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
885 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
886 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
887 specified in a proxy.
888
889 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
890 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
891 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
892 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
893 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
894 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
895 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
896
897 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
898 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
899 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
900 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
901 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
902
903 Example:
904 global
905 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
906
907 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
908 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
909
910h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
911 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
912 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
913 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
914 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
915 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
916 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
917 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
918 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
919
920 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
921 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
922 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
923
924 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
925 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
926
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100927insecure-fork-wanted
928 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
929 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
930 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
931 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
932 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
933 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
934 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
935 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
936 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
937 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
938 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
939 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
940 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
941 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
942 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
943 disable it.
944
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100945insecure-setuid-wanted
946 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
947 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
948 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
949 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
950 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
951 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
952 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
953 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
954 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
955 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
956 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
957 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
958 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
959 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
960
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100961issuers-chain-path <dir>
962 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
963 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
964 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
965 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
966 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
967 "issuers-chain-path".
968 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
969 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
970 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
971 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
972 will share the chain in memory.
973
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200974localpeer <name>
975 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
976 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
977 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
978 the configuration parsing.
979
980 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
981 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
982
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200983log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
984 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100985 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100986 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100987 configured with "log global".
988
989 <address> can be one of:
990
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100991 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100992 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
993 port).
994
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100995 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
996 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
997 port).
998
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100999 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001000 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1001 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001002 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001003
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001004 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1005 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1006 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1007 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1008 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1009 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1010 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1011 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1012 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1013 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1014 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1015 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1016 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1017 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001018 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1019 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001020
1021 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1022 "fd@2", see above.
1023
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001024 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1025 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1026 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1027 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1028 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1029
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001030 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1031 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001032
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001033 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1034 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1035 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1036 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1037 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1038 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1039 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1040 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1041 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1042 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001043 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1044 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001045
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001046 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1047 one of the following :
1048
1049 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1050 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1051
1052 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1053 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1054
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001055 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1056 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1057 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1058 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1059 logger consumes.
1060
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001061 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1062 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1063 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1064 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1065
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001066 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1067 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1068 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1069 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1070 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1071
1072 <sample_size>
1073 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1074 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1075 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1076 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1077 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1078
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001079 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001081 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1082 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1083 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1084
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001085 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1086 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1087 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1088 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089
1090 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001091 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1092 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1093 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1094 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1095 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1096 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001097
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001098 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001100log-send-hostname [<string>]
1101 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1102 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1103 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1104 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1105 the logs.
1106
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001107log-tag <string>
1108 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1109 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1110 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001111 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001112
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001113lua-load <file>
1114 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1115 used multiple times.
1116
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001117lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1118 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1119 variable.
1120 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1121 to "path".
1122
1123 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1124 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1125 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1126 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1127 will be checked earlier.
1128
1129 As an example by specifying the following path:
1130
1131 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1132 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1133
1134 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1135 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1136 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1137 paths if that does not exist either.
1138
1139 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1140 documentation.
1141
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001142master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1144 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1145 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001146 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001147 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1148 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001149 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1150 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1151 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1152 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1153 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001154
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001155 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001156
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001157mworker-max-reloads <number>
1158 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001159 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001160 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1161 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1162 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1163
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001164nbproc <number>
1165 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1166 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1167 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001168 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1169 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001170 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1171 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001172
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001173nbthread <number>
1174 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001175 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1176 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1177 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1178 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1179 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001180 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1181 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1182 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1183 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1184 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1185 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1186 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001187
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001189 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001190 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1191 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1192
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001193pp2-never-send-local
1194 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1195 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1196 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1197 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1198 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1199 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1200 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1201 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1202 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1203 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1204 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1205
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001206presetenv <name> <value>
1207 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1208 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1209 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1210 and "unsetenv".
1211
1212resetenv [<name> ...]
1213 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1214 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1215 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1216 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1217 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1218 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1219 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1220 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1221
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001222stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001223 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1224 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1225 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1226 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1227 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1228 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001229 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001230 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1231 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1232 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1233 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001234
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001235server-state-base <directory>
1236 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001237 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1238 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001239
1240server-state-file <file>
1241 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1242 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1243 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1244 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1245 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1246 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1247 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1248 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001249 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1250 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001251
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001252setenv <name> <value>
1253 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1254 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1255 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1256 and "unsetenv".
1257
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001258set-dumpable
1259 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001260 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1261 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1262 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1263 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1264 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1265 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1266 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1267 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1268 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1269 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1270 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1271 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1272 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1273 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1274 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1275 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1276 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001277
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001278ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1280 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001281 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001282 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001283 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1284 information and recommendations see e.g.
1285 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1286 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1287 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1288 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001289
1290ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1292 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1293 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1294 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1295 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001296 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1297 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1298 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001299 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001300
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001301ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1303 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1304 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1305 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1306 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1307
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001308ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1310 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1311 keyword to see available options.
1312
1313 Example:
1314 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001315 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001316
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001317ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1319 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001320 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001321 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001322 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1323 information and recommendations see e.g.
1324 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1325 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1326 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1327 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1328 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001329
1330ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1332 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1333 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1334 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1335 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001336 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1337 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1338 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1339 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001340
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001341ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1342 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1343 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1344 keyword to see available options.
1345
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001346ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1348 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1349 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001350 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001351 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001352 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1353 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1354 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1355 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001356 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1357 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1358 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1359
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001360ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001361 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1362 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1363
1364 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1365 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1366 optimize the startup time.
1367
1368 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1369 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1370 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1371
1372 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001373 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001374
1375 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1376 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1377 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1378 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1379 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1380 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001381 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001382 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1383
1384 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1385
1386 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1387
1388 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1389 not provided in the PEM file.
1390
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001391 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1392 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1393
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001394 The default behavior is "all".
1395
1396 Example:
1397 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1398 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1399 ssl-load-extra-files none
1400
1401 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1402
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001403ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1404 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1405 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1406 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1407
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001408ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1409 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1410 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1411 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1412 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1413 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1414 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1415 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1416 bits does not need it.
1417
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001418stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1419 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1420 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1421 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001422 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001423 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001424
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001425 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1426 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1427 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001428
1429stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1430 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1431 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001432 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001433
1434stats maxconn <connections>
1435 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1436 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1437
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001438uid <number>
1439 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1440 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1441 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1442 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1443
1444ulimit-n <number>
1445 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1446 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1447 option.
1448
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001449unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1450 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1451
1452 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1453 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1454 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1455 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1456 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1457 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1458 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1459 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1460 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1461 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1462
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001463unsetenv [<name> ...]
1464 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1465 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1466 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1467 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1468 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1469 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1470 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1471
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001472user <user name>
1473 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1474 See also "uid" and "group".
1475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001476node <name>
1477 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1478
1479 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1480 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1481 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1482 traffic.
1483
1484description <text>
1485 Add a text that describes the instance.
1486
1487 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1488 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1489 "<" and ">" characters.
1490
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100149151degrees-data-file <file path>
1492 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001493 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001494
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001495 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001496 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1497
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000149851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001499 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1500 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1501 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1502
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001503 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001504 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1505
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200150651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001507 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1508 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1509
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001510 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1511 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1512
151351degrees-cache-size <number>
1514 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1515 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1516 By default, this cache is disabled.
1517
1518 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001519 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1520
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001521wurfl-data-file <file path>
1522 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1523 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1524
1525 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1526 with USE_WURFL=1.
1527
1528wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1529 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1530 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1531 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1532
1533 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1534
1535 Valid WURFL properties are:
1536 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1537
1538 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1539 device.
1540
1541 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1542 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1543
1544 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1545 particular web request.
1546
1547 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1548 used Libwurfl API version.
1549
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001550 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1551 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1552
1553 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1554 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1555
1556 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1557
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001558 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1559 with USE_WURFL=1.
1560
1561wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1562 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1563 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1564
1565 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1566 with USE_WURFL=1.
1567
1568wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1569 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1570 thus before the chroot.
1571
1572 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1573 with USE_WURFL=1.
1574
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001575wurfl-cache-size <size>
1576 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1577 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001578 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001579 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001580
1581 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1582 with USE_WURFL=1.
1583
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001584strict-limits
1585 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1586 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1587 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1588 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1589 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1590 keyword.
1591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001593-----------------------
1594
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001595busy-polling
1596 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1597 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1598 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1599 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1600 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1601 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1602 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1603 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1604 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1605 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1606 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1607 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1608 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1609 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1610 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1611 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1612 "poll" pollers.
1613
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001614 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1615 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1616 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1617
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001618max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1619 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1620 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1621 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1622 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1623 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1624 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1625 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1626 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001628maxconn <number>
1629 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1630 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1631 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001632 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1633 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1634 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1635 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001636 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1637 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1638 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1639 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1640 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1641 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001642
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001643maxconnrate <number>
1644 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1645 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1646 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1647 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1648 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1649 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1650 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1651 fairness.
1652
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001653maxcomprate <number>
1654 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001655 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001656 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1657 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1658 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001659 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001660 default value.
1661
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001662maxcompcpuusage <number>
1663 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1664 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1665 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1666 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1667 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1668 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1669 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1670 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1671
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001672maxpipes <number>
1673 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1674 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1675 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1676 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1677 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1678 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1679
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001680maxsessrate <number>
1681 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1682 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1683 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1684 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1685 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1686 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1687 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1688 fairness.
1689
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001690maxsslconn <number>
1691 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1692 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1693 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1694 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1695 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1696 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1697 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001698 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1699 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1700 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1701 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1702 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1703 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1704 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001705
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001706maxsslrate <number>
1707 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1708 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1709 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1710 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1711 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1712 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1713 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1714 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1715 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1716 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1717
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001718maxzlibmem <number>
1719 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1720 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1721 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001722 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1723 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1724 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001726noepoll
1727 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1728 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001729 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001730
1731nokqueue
1732 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1733 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1734 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1735
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001736noevports
1737 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1738 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1739 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1740 also "nopoll".
1741
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001742nopoll
1743 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1744 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001746 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1747 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001748
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001749nosplice
1750 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001751 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001752 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001753 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001754 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1755 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1756 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1757 "option splice-response".
1758
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001759nogetaddrinfo
1760 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1761 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1762
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001763noreuseport
1764 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1765 command line argument "-dR".
1766
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001767profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1768 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1769 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1770 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1771 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001772 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001773 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1774 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1775 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1776 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1777
1778 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1779 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1780 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1781 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1782 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001783 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1784 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1785 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1786 CLI.
1787
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001788spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001789 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1790 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1791 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1792 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1793 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1794 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001795
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001797 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001798 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001799 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1800 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1801 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1802 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1803 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001804 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1805 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001806 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1807 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1808 openssl configuration file uses:
1809 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1810
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001811ssl-mode-async
1812 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001813 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001814 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1815 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1816 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001817 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001818 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001819
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001820tune.buffers.limit <number>
1821 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1822 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1823 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1824 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1825 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001826 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001827 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1828 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1829 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1830 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1831 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1832 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1833 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1834 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1835 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1836
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001837tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1838 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1839 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1840 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1841 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1842
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001843tune.bufsize <number>
1844 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1845 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1846 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1847 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1848 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1849 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1850 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001851 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1852 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1853 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001854 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001855 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1856 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1857 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001858
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001859tune.chksize <number>
1860 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1861 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1862 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1863 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1864 checks whenever possible.
1865
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001866tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1867 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1868 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1869 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1870 this value. The default value is 1.
1871
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001872tune.fail-alloc
1873 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1874 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1875 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1876 gracefully.
1877
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001878tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1879 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1880 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1881 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1882 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1883 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1884
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001885tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1886 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1887 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1888 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1889 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1890 change it.
1891
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001892tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1893 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001894 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1895 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001896 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1897 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1898 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1899 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1900 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1901
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001902tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1903 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1904 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1905 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1906 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1907 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1908 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1909 recommended not to change this value.
1910
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001911tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1912 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1913 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1914 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1915 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1916 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1917 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1918 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1919
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001920tune.http.cookielen <number>
1921 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1922 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1923 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1924 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1925 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1926 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1927 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1928 to change this value.
1929
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001930tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001931 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1932 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001933 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001934 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001935 configuration directives too.
1936 The default value is 1024.
1937
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001938tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1939 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1940 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1941 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1942 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1943 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1944 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001945 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1946 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1947 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001948
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001949tune.idletimer <timeout>
1950 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1951 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1952 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1953 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1954 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1955 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001956 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001957 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001958 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1959
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001960tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1961 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1962 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1963 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1964 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1965 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1966 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1967 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1968 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1969 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1970
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001971tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1972 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001973 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001974 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1975 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001976 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001977 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1978 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1979
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001980tune.lua.maxmem
1981 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1982 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1983 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1984 memory.
1985
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001986tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1987 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001988 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1989 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001990 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001991
1992tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1993 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1994 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1995 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1996 check servers.
1997
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001998tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1999 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2000 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2001 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002002 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002003
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002004tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002005 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2006 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2007 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2008 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2009 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2010 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2011 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2012 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2013 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2014 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002015
2016tune.maxpollevents <number>
2017 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2018 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2019 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2020 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2021 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2022
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002023tune.maxrewrite <number>
2024 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2025 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2026 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2027 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2028 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2029 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2030 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2031 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2032 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2033 bufsize.
2034
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002035tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2036 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2037 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2038 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2039 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2040 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2041 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2042 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2043 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2044 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002045 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2046 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002047 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2048 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2049 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2050 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2051 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2052 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2053 setting this parameter to 0.
2054
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002055tune.pipesize <number>
2056 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2057 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2058 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2059 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2060 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2061 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2062
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002063tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2064 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2065 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2066 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2067 default is 20.
2068
2069tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2070 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2071 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2072 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2073 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2074 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2075 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002076 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002077
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002078tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2079tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2080 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2081 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2082 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002083 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002084 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002085 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2086 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2087
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002088tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002089 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002090 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2091 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2092 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2093 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2094
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002095tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002096 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002097 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2098 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2099
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002100tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2101tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2102 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2103 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2104 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002105 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002106 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002107 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2108 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2109 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2110 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2111 notifying haproxy again.
2112
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002113tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002114 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2115 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2116 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002117 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002118 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002119 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002120 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2121 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2122 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002123 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2124 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002125
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002126tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002127 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002128 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2129 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2130 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2131 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2132 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2133
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002134tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2135 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002136 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002137 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2138 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2139 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2140 being used for too long.
2141
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002142tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2143 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2144 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2145 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2146 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2147 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2148 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2149 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2150 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2151 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2152 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002153 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002154 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002155
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002156tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2157 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2158 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2159 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2160 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002161 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002162 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2163 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002164 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2165 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002166
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002167tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2168 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2169 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2170 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2171 1000 entries.
2172
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002173tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2174 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2175 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2176 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2177
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002178tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002179tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002180tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2181tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2182tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002183 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2184 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2185 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2186 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2187 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2188 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2189 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2190 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002191
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002192 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2193 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2194 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2195 all available space is consumed.
2196 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2197 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2198 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002199
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002200tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2201 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002202 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002203 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002204 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002205 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2206
2207tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2208 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2209 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002210 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2211 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022133.3. Debugging
2214--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002215
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002216debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002217 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2218 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2219 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2220 system startup.
2221
2222quiet
2223 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2224 line argument "-q".
2225
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002226zero-warning
2227 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2228 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2229 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2230 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2231 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2232 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2233
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022353.4. Userlists
2236--------------
2237It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2238http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2239it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2240
2241userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002242 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002243 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2244
2245group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002246 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002247 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2248 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2249
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002250user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2251 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002252 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2253 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002254 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2255 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2256 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2257 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002258
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002259 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2260 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2261 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2262 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2263 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2264 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2265 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2266 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2267 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002268
2269 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002270 userlist L1
2271 group G1 users tiger,scott
2272 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002273
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002274 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2275 user scott insecure-password elgato
2276 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002277
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002278 userlist L2
2279 group G1
2280 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002281
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002282 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2283 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2284 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002285
2286 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002287
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002288
22893.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002290----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002291It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2292several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2293instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2294values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2295automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2296In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2297using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2298tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2299reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2300Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2301that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2302each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002303
2304peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002305 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002306 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2307
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2309 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2310 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2311
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002312disabled
2313 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2314 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2315 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2316
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002317default-bind [param*]
2318 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2319
2320default-server [param*]
2321 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2322
2323 Arguments:
2324 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2325 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2326 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2327 details.
2328
2329
2330 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2331
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002332enable
2333 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2334
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002335log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2336 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2337 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2338 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2339 more details.
2340
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002341peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2343 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002344 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2345 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2346 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2347 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2348 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002349
2350 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2351 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2352
2353 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002354 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2355 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2356 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002357
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002358 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2359 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002360
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002361 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2362 "server" keyword explanation below).
2363
2364server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002365 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002366 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2367 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2368 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2369 of this "peers" section).
2370 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2371
2372
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002373 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002374 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002375 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002376 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2377 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2378 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002379
2380 backend mybackend
2381 mode tcp
2382 balance roundrobin
2383 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2384 stick on src
2385
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002386 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2387 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002388
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002389 Example:
2390 peers mypeers
2391 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2392 default-server ssl verify none
2393 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2394 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002395
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002396
2397table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2398 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2399
2400 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2401 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002402 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002403 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2404 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2405 "stick-table" keyword).
2406
2407 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2408 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2409 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2410 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2411 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2412 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2413 of the stick-table name as follows:
2414
2415 peers mypeers
2416 peer A ...
2417 peer B ...
2418 table t1 ...
2419
2420 frontend fe1
2421 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2422
2423 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2424 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2425
2426 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2427 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2428 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2429 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2430 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2431 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2432 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2433
2434 peers mypeers
2435 peer A ...
2436 peer B ...
2437 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2438
2439 backend t1
2440 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2441
2442 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2443 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2444 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2445
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024463.6. Mailers
2447------------
2448It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2449If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2450in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2451
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002452mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002453 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2454 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2455
2456mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2457 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2458
2459 Example:
2460 mailers mymailers
2461 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2462 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2463
2464 backend mybackend
2465 mode tcp
2466 balance roundrobin
2467
2468 email-alert mailers mymailers
2469 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2470 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2471
2472 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2473 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2474
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002475timeout mail <time>
2476 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2477 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2478 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2479 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2480
2481 Example:
2482 mailers mymailers
2483 timeout mail 20s
2484 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002485
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024863.7. Programs
2487-------------
2488In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2489master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2490managed the same way as the workers.
2491
2492During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2493sequence as a worker:
2494
2495 - the master is re-executed
2496 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2497 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2498 instance of the program
2499
2500During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2501
2502program <name>
2503 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2504 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2505 the management guide).
2506
2507command <command> [arguments*]
2508 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2509 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2510 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2511 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2512
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002513user <user name>
2514 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2515 See also "group".
2516
2517group <group name>
2518 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2519 See also "user".
2520
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002521option start-on-reload
2522no option start-on-reload
2523 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2524 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2525 program section.
2526
2527
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025283.8. HTTP-errors
2529----------------
2530
2531It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2532imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2533several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2534
2535http-errors <name>
2536 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2537 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2538
2539errorfile <code> <file>
2540 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2541
2542 Arguments :
2543 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002544 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2545 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002546
2547 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2548 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2549 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2550 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2551 before any chroot is performed.
2552
2553 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2554
2555 Example:
2556 http-errors website-1
2557 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2558 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2559 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2560
2561 http-errors website-2
2562 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2563 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2564 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2565
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020025663.9. Rings
2567----------
2568
2569It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2570servers or traces.
2571
2572ring <ringname>
2573 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2574
2575description <text>
2576 The descritpition is an optional description string of the ring. It will
2577 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2578
2579format <format>
2580 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2581
2582 Arguments:
2583 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2584 one of the following :
2585
2586 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2587 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2588 designed to be used with a local log server.
2589
2590 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2591 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2592 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2593 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2594 is the default.
2595
2596 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2597 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2598
2599 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2600 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2601
2602 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2603 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2604 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2605 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2606 logger consumes.
2607
2608 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2609 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2610 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2611 used with a local log server.
2612
2613maxlen <length>
2614 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2615 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2616 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2617
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002618server <name> <address> [param*]
2619 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2620 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2621 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2622 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2623 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2624 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2625 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2626 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2627 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002628 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2629 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002630
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002631size <size>
2632 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2633 set to BUFSIZE.
2634
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002635timeout connect <timeout>
2636 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2637
2638 Arguments :
2639 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2640 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2641 as explained at the top of this document.
2642
2643timeout server <timeout>
2644 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2645
2646 Arguments :
2647 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2648 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2649 as explained at the top of this document.
2650
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002651 Example:
2652 global
2653 log ring@myring local7
2654
2655 ring myring
2656 description "My local buffer"
2657 format rfc3164
2658 maxlen 1200
2659 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002660 timeout connect 5s
2661 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002662 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002663
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026654. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002666----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002668Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002669 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002670 - frontend <name>
2671 - backend <name>
2672 - listen <name>
2673
2674A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2675its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2676section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002678
2679A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2680connections.
2681
2682A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2683to forward incoming connections.
2684
2685A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2686parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002688All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2689'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2690case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2691
2692Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2693logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2694proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2695However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2696name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2697
2698Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2699and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002700bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002701protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2702modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2703arbitrary criteria.
2704
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002705In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2706a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002707the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002708
2709 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2710 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2711 between responses and new requests.
2712
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002713 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2714 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2715 client-facing connection remains open.
2716
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002717 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2718 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002719
2720The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2721frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2722following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002723weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002724
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002725 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002726
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002727 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2728 ----+-----+-----+----
2729 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2730 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002731 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2732 ----+-----+-----+----
2733 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027374.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2738--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002740The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2741limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2742they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2743limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002744marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002745option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002746and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2747with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2748specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002750
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002751 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2752------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2753acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002754backlog X X X -
2755balance X - X X
2756bind - X X -
2757bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002758capture cookie - X X -
2759capture request header - X X -
2760capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002761compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002762cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002763declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002764default-server X - X X
2765default_backend X X X -
2766description - X X X
2767disabled X X X X
2768dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002769email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002770email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002771email-alert mailers X X X X
2772email-alert myhostname X X X X
2773email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002774enabled X X X X
2775errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002776errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777errorloc X X X X
2778errorloc302 X X X X
2779-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2780errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002781force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002782filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002783fullconn X - X X
2784grace X X X X
2785hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002786http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002787http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002788http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002789http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002790http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002791http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002792http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002793http-check set-var X - X X
2794http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002795http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002796http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002797http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002798http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002799http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002800id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002801ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002802load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002803log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002804log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002805log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002806log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002807max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002808maxconn X X X -
2809mode X X X X
2810monitor fail - X X -
2811monitor-net X X X -
2812monitor-uri X X X -
2813option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2814option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2815option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2816option allbackups (*) X - X X
2817option checkcache (*) X - X X
2818option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2819option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002820option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002821option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2822option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002823-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2824option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002825option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2826option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002827option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002828option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002829option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002830option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002831option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002832option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2833option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2834option httpchk X - X X
2835option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002836option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002837option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002838option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002839option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002840option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002841option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2842option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2843option logasap (*) X X X -
2844option mysql-check X - X X
2845option nolinger (*) X X X X
2846option originalto X X X X
2847option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002848option pgsql-check X - X X
2849option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002850option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002851option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002852option smtpchk X - X X
2853option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2854option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2855option splice-request (*) X X X X
2856option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002857option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002858option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2859option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2860-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002861option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002862option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2863option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2864option tcpka X X X X
2865option tcplog X X X X
2866option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002867external-check command X - X X
2868external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002869persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2870rate-limit sessions X X X -
2871redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002872-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002873retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002874retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002875server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002876server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002877server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002878source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002879stats admin - X X X
2880stats auth X X X X
2881stats enable X X X X
2882stats hide-version X X X X
2883stats http-request - X X X
2884stats realm X X X X
2885stats refresh X X X X
2886stats scope X X X X
2887stats show-desc X X X X
2888stats show-legends X X X X
2889stats show-node X X X X
2890stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002891-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2892stick match - - X X
2893stick on - - X X
2894stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002895stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002896stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002897tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002898tcp-check connect X - X X
2899tcp-check expect X - X X
2900tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002901tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002902tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002903tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002904tcp-check set-var X - X X
2905tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002906tcp-request connection - X X -
2907tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002908tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002909tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002910tcp-response content - - X X
2911tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002912timeout check X - X X
2913timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002914timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002915timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002916timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2917timeout http-request X X X X
2918timeout queue X - X X
2919timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002920timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002921timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002922timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002923transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002924unique-id-format X X X -
2925unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002926use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002927use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002928use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002929------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2930 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002931
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029334.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2934---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935
2936This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2937
2938
2939acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2940 Declare or complete an access list.
2941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2942 no | yes | yes | yes
2943 Example:
2944 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2945 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2946 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002948 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002949
2950
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002951backlog <conns>
2952 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2954 yes | yes | yes | no
2955 Arguments :
2956 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2957 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002958 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002959
2960 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2961 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2962 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2963 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2964 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2965 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2966 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2967 backlog parameter.
2968
2969 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2970 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2971 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2972
2973 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2974
2975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002977balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2980 yes | no | yes | yes
2981 Arguments :
2982 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2983 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2984 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2985 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2986
2987 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2988 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2989 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2990 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002991 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002992 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002993 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2994 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2995 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2996 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2997 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2998 it, so that you don't worry.
2999
3000 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3001 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3002 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3003 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3004 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3005 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3006 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3007 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003009 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3010 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3011 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3012 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3013 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3014 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3015 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3016 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3017
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003018 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003019 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003020 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3021 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003022 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003023 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3024 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3025 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3026 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3027 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003028 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3029 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3030 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3031 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3032 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3033 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3036 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3037 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3038 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3039 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3040 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3041 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3042 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003043 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003044 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003045 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3046 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3047 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003048
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003049 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3050 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3051 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3052 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3053 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3054 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3055 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3056 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3057 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3058 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3059 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3060 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003061
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003062 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003063 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3064 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3065 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3066 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3067 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3068 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3069 URIs start with a leading "/".
3070
3071 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3072 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3073 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3074 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003076 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003077 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3078
3079 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003080 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3081 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003082 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3083 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3084 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3085 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003086 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003087 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3088 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003089
3090 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3091 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3092 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3093 server will receive the request.
3094
3095 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3096 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3097 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3098 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3099 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003100 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3101 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3102 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003103
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003104 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3105 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3106 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3107 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3108 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003109
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003110 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003111 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3112 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3113 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3114
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003115 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3116 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3117 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3118
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003119 random
3120 random(<draws>)
3121 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003122 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3123 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3124 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3125 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003126 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3127 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3128 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3129 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3130 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3131 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3132 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3133 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3134 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3135 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3136 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3137 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3138 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3139 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3140 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3141 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3142 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3143 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3144 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3145 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003146
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003147 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003148 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003149 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3150 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3151 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3152 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3153 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3154 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003155 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003156 used instead.
3157
3158 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3159 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3160 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3161 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3162
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003163 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3164 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3165 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3166
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003167 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003170 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3171 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003172
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003173 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3174 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3175 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003177 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003178 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003179 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3180 NTLM relies on.
3181
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182 Examples :
3183 balance roundrobin
3184 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003185 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003186 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3187 balance hdr(host)
3188 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003189
3190 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3191 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003193 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003194 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3195 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3196 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003197 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003198
3199 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3200 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3201 defaults to 16 kB.
3202
3203 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3204 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3205
3206 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3207 Round Robin.
3208
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003209 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003210 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3211 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3212 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3213
3214 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3215
3216 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003217 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003218 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3219 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3220 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003221
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003222 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003223
3224
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003225bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3226bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003227 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3229 no | yes | yes | no
3230 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003231 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3232 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3233 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3234 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003235 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003236 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3237 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3238 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3239 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3240 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3241 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3242 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003243 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3244 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3245 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3246 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3247 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3248 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3249 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003250 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3251 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3252 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003253 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3254 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3255 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3256 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003257 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3258 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3259 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003260
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003261 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3262 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003263 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3264 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3265 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003266 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3267 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3268 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3269 the range.
3270
3271 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3272 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3273 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3274 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3275 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3276 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3277 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003278 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003279 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003280
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003281 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003282 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003283 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3284 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3285 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3286 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3287 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3288 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3289
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003290 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3291 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3292 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3293 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003294
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3296 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3297 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3298 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3299 in a frontend.
3300
3301 Example :
3302 listen http_proxy
3303 bind :80,:443
3304 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003305 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003307 listen http_https_proxy
3308 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003309 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003310
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003311 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3312 bind ipv6@:80
3313 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3314 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3315
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003316 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003317 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003318
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003319 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3320 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3321 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3322 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3323 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3324
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003325 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003326 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
3328
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003329bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003330 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3332 yes | yes | yes | yes
3333 Arguments :
3334 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3335 may be used to override a default value.
3336
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003337 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003338 option may be combined with other numbers.
3339
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003340 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003341 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3342 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3343 missing from all processes.
3344
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003345 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003346 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003347 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3348 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3349 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3350 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3351 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003352 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003353
3354 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3355 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3356 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3357 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3358 and 'even' instances.
3359
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003360 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3361 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3362 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3363 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003364
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003365 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3366 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3367
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003368 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3369 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3370 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3371
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003372 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3373 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3374
3375 Example :
3376 listen app_ip1
3377 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003378 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003379
3380 listen app_ip2
3381 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003382 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003383
3384 listen management
3385 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003386 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003387
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003388 listen management
3389 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3390 bind-process 1-4
3391
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003392 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003393
3394
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395capture cookie <name> len <length>
3396 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3398 no | yes | yes | no
3399 Arguments :
3400 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3401 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3402 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3403 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003404 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
3406 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3407 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3408 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3409 right if it exceeds <length>.
3410
3411 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3412 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3413 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3414 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3415
3416 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3417 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3418 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3419
3420 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3421 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3422 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003423 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3424 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3425 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426
3427 Example:
3428 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3429
3430 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003431 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003432
3433
3434capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003435 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3437 no | yes | yes | no
3438 Arguments :
3439 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003440 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003441 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3442 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3443 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3444
3445 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3446 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3447 it exceeds <length>.
3448
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003449 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3451 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003452 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3453 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3454 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3455 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003456 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003457 environments to find where the request came from.
3458
3459 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3460 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3461 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3462 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003464 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3465 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3466 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3467 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3468 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003469
3470 Example:
3471 capture request header Host len 15
3472 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003473 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003475 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476 about logging.
3477
3478
3479capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003480 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3482 no | yes | yes | no
3483 Arguments :
3484 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003485 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003486 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3487 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3488 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3489
3490 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3491 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3492 it exceeds <length>.
3493
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003494 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003495 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3496 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3497 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003498 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3499 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3500 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3501 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003503 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3504 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3505 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3506 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3507 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003508
3509 Example:
3510 capture response header Content-length len 9
3511 capture response header Location len 15
3512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003513 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514 about logging.
3515
3516
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003517compression algo <algorithm> ...
3518compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003519compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003520 Enable HTTP compression.
3521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3522 yes | yes | yes | yes
3523 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003524 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3525 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3526 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3527
3528 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003529 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3530 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3531 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003532
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003533 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003534 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003535
3536 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3537 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3538 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3539 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3540 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003541 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003542
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003543 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3544 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3545 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3546 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3547 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3548 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3549 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003550 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003551
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003552 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003553 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003554 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3555 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3556 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3557 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3558 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003559
3560 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3561 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3562 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3563 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3564 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003565 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3566 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3567 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3568 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3569 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003570 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3571 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003572
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003573 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003574 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3575 "Accept-Encoding" header
3576 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003577 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003578 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3579 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3580 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3581 "multipart"
3582 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3583 header
3584 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3585 and later
3586 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3587 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003588 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003589
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003590 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003591
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003592 Examples :
3593 compression algo gzip
3594 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003596
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003597cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003598 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3599 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003600 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003601 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3603 yes | no | yes | yes
3604 Arguments :
3605 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3606 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3607 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3608 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3609 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3610 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003611 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3613 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3614
3615 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3616 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3617 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3618 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3619 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3620 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003621 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3622 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003623 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003624 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3625 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003626
3627 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003628 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003629
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003630 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003631 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003632 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003633 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003634 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3635 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3636 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3637 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3638 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3639 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3640 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641
3642 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3643 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3644 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3645 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3646 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3647 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3648 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3649 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3650 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003651 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003652 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3653 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3654 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003656 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3657 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3658 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003659 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3660 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3661 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3662 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003663 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3664 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3665 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003666
3667 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3668 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3669 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3670 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3671 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3672 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3673 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3674 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3675 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3676
3677 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3678 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3679 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3680 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3681 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3682 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3683 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3684 persistence cookie in the cache.
3685 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3686
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003687 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3688 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3689 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3690 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3691 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003692 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003693 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3694 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3695 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3696 they logout.
3697
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003698 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3699 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3700 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3701 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3702
3703 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3704 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3705 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3706 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3707 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3708 this attribute.
3709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003710 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003711 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003712 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3713 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3714 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3715 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3716 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3717 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003718
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003719 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3720 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3721 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3722 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3723 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3724 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3725 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3726 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003727 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003728 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3729 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3730 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3731 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3732 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3733 the site.
3734
3735 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3736 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3737 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3738 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3739 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3740 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3741 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3742 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3743 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3744 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3745 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3746 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3747 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003748 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003749 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3750 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3751
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003752 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3753 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3754 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3755 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3756 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3757 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3758
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003759 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3760 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3761 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3762 repeated.
3763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003764 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3765 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3766 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3767 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003769 Examples :
3770 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3771 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3772 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003773 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003774
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003775 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003776
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003777
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003778declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3779 Declares a capture slot.
3780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 no | yes | yes | no
3782 Arguments:
3783 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3784
3785 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3786 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3787 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3788 for use in the response.
3789
3790 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003791 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003792 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3793
3794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003795default-server [param*]
3796 Change default options for a server in a backend
3797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3798 yes | no | yes | yes
3799 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003800 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3801 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3802 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3803 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003804
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003805 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003806 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3807
3808 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003809
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003811default_backend <backend>
3812 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3814 yes | yes | yes | no
3815 Arguments :
3816 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3817
3818 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3819 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3820 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3821 will catch all undetermined requests.
3822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003823 Example :
3824
3825 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3826 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3827 default_backend dynamic
3828
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003829 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003830
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003831
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003832description <string>
3833 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3835 no | yes | yes | yes
3836 Arguments : string
3837
3838 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3839 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3840 it describes.
3841 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3842
3843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003844disabled
3845 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3847 yes | yes | yes | yes
3848 Arguments : none
3849
3850 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3851 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3852 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3853 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3854 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3855 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3856 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3857
3858 See also : "enabled"
3859
3860
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003861dispatch <address>:<port>
3862 Set a default server address
3863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3864 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003865 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003866
3867 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3868 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3869 during start-up.
3870
3871 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3872 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3873 possible with normal servers.
3874
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003875 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003876 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3877 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3878 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3879 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3880
3881 See also : "server"
3882
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003883
3884dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3885 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3887 yes | no | yes | yes
3888 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3889
3890 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003891 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003892 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3893 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003894 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003895 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003897enabled
3898 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3900 yes | yes | yes | yes
3901 Arguments : none
3902
3903 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3904 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3905
3906 See also : "disabled"
3907
3908
3909errorfile <code> <file>
3910 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3912 yes | yes | yes | yes
3913 Arguments :
3914 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003915 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
3916 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003917
3918 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003919 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003921 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3922 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003923
3924 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3925 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3926 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3927
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003928 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3929
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02003930 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
3931 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
3932 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
3933 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
3934 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
3935 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
3936 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
3937 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
3938 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003940 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3941 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3942 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003943 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003944 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3945
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003946 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003947
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003948 Example :
3949 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003950 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003951 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3952 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3953
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003954
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003955errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3956 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3957 section.
3958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | yes | yes | yes
3960 Arguments :
3961 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3962
3963 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003964 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
3965 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003966
3967 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3968 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3969 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3970 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3971 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3972 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3973 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3974
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003975 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
3976 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003977
3978 Example :
3979 errorfiles generic
3980 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3981
3982
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003983errorloc <code> <url>
3984errorloc302 <code> <url>
3985 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | yes | yes | yes
3988 Arguments :
3989 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003990 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
3991 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003992
3993 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3994 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3995 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3996 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003997 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003998
3999 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4000 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4001 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4002
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004003 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4004
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004005 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4006 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4007 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4008 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004009 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004010 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4011 request.
4012
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004013 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004014
4015
4016errorloc303 <code> <url>
4017 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4019 yes | yes | yes | yes
4020 Arguments :
4021 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004022 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
4023 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004024
4025 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4026 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4027 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4028 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004029 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004030
4031 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4032 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4033 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4034
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004035 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4036
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004037 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4038 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4039 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4040 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004041 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004042
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004043 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004044
4045
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004046email-alert from <emailaddr>
4047 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004048 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004049 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4050 yes | yes | yes | yes
4051
4052 Arguments :
4053
4054 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4055
4056 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4057 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4058
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004059 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004060 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4061 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004062
4063
4064email-alert level <level>
4065 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4066 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4068 yes | yes | yes | yes
4069
4070 Arguments :
4071
4072 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4073 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4074 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4075
4076 By default level is alert
4077
4078 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4079 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4080 for the proxy.
4081
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004082 Alerts are sent when :
4083
4084 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4085 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4086 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4087 is notice or lower
4088 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4089 and a health check status update occurs
4090
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004091 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4092 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004093 section 3.6 about mailers.
4094
4095
4096email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4097 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4098 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4099 yes | yes | yes | yes
4100
4101 Arguments :
4102
4103 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4104
4105 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4106 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4107
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004108 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4109 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004110
4111
4112email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4113 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4114 mailers.
4115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4116 yes | yes | yes | yes
4117
4118 Arguments :
4119
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004120 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004121
4122 By default the systems hostname is used.
4123
4124 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4125 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4126 for the proxy.
4127
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004128 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4129 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004130
4131
4132email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004133 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004134 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4135 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4136 yes | yes | yes | yes
4137
4138 Arguments :
4139
4140 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4141
4142 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4143 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4144
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004145 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004146 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4147
4148
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004149force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4150 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004152 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004153
4154 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4155 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4156 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4157 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4158 marked down for maintenance operations.
4159
4160 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4161 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4162 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4163 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4164 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4165 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4166 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4167 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4168 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4169
4170 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4171 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4172 is used.
4173
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004174 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004175 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004176
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004177
4178filter <name> [param*]
4179 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4181 no | yes | yes | yes
4182 Arguments :
4183 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4184 referenced in section 9.
4185
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004186 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004187 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004188 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4189 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004190
4191 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4192 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4193
4194 Example:
4195 listen
4196 bind *:80
4197
4198 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4199 filter compression
4200 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4201
4202 compression algo gzip
4203 compression offload
4204
4205 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4206
4207 See also : section 9.
4208
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004209
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004210fullconn <conns>
4211 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4213 yes | no | yes | yes
4214 Arguments :
4215 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4216 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4217
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004218 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004219 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004220 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004221 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4222 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4223 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4224 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4225 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004226 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004227
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004228 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4229 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004230 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4231 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4232 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004233
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004234 Example :
4235 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4236 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4237 # connections.
4238 backend dynamic
4239 fullconn 10000
4240 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4241 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4242
4243 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4244
4245
4246grace <time>
4247 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004249 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004250 Arguments :
4251 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4252 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4253 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4254
4255 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4256 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004257 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004258 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4259
4260 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4261 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4262 simplify it.
4263
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004264
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004265hash-balance-factor <factor>
4266 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | no | no | yes
4269 Arguments :
4270 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4271 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004272 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004273
4274 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4275 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4276 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4277 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4278 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4279 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4280 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4281
4282 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4283 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4284 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4285 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4286 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4287
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004288 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4289 consistent hashing mechanism.
4290
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004291 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4292
4293
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004294hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004295 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 yes | no | yes | yes
4298 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004299 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4300 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004301
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004302 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4303 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4304 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4305 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4306 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4307 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4308 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4309 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4310 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4311 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004312
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004313 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4314 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4315 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4316 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4317 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4318 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4319 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4320 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4321 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4322 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4323 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4324 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4325 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004326 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4327 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004328
4329 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4330
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004331 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004332 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4333 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4334 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004335 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4336 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4337 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004338
4339 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4340 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004341 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4342 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4343 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4344 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4345
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004346 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4347 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4348 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4349 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4350 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4351 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4352 parameter.
4353
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004354 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4355 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4356 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4357 used on strings.
4358
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004359 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4360
4361 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4362 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4363 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4364 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4365 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4366 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4367 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4368 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4369 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4370 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4371 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4372 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004373
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004374 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4375 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4376 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004377
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004378 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004379
4380
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004381http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4382 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4383 ones).
4384
4385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4386 no | yes | yes | yes
4387
4388 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4389 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4390 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4391 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4392 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4393 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4394
4395 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4396 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4397 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4398
4399 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4400 below.
4401
4402 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4403 instance.
4404
4405 Example:
4406 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4407 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4408 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4409
4410http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4411
4412 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4413 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4414 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4415 example, or to pass some internal information.
4416 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4417 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4418 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4419
4420http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4421
4422 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4423 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4424
4425http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4426
4427 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4428
4429http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4430 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4431
4432 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4433
4434 Example:
4435 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4436
4437 # applied to:
4438 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4439
4440 # outputs:
4441 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4442
4443 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4444
4445http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4447
4448 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4449
4450 Example:
4451 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4452
4453 # applied to:
4454 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4455
4456 # outputs:
4457 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4458
4459http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4460
4461 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4462 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4463 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4464
4465http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4466 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4467
4468 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4469 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4470 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4471 fallback.
4472
4473 Example:
4474 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4475 http-response set-status 431
4476 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4477 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4478
4479http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4480
4481 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4482 inline.
4483
4484 Arguments:
4485 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4486 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4487 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4488 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4489 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4490 (request and response)
4491 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4492 processing
4493 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4494 processing
4495 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4496 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4497 and '_'.
4498
4499 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4500 followed by some converters.
4501
4502 Example:
4503 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4504
4505http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4506
4507 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4508 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4509 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4510 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4511 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004512 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004513 processing.
4514
4515 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4516 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4517 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4518 rules evaluation.
4519
4520http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4521
4522 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4523 details about <var-name>.
4524
4525 Example:
4526 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4527
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004528
4529http-check comment <string>
4530 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4531 it fails.
4532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4533 yes | no | yes | yes
4534
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004535 Arguments :
4536 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4537 rule fails.
4538
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004539 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4540 user-friendly error reporting.
4541
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004542 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4543 "http-check expect".
4544
4545
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004546http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4547 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004548 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004549 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4551 yes | no | yes | yes
4552
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004553 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004554 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4555
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004556 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4557 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4558
4559 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4560 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4561 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4562 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4563
4564 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4565
4566 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4567
4568 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4569
4570 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4571
4572 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4573
4574 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4575 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4576 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4577 is used.
4578
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004579 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4580 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4581 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4582 haproxy -vv.
4583
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004584 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4585
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004586 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4587 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4588 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4589 different ports or with different servers.
4590
4591 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4592 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4593 the port with a "http-check connect".
4594
4595 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4596 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4597 do.
4598
4599 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4600 unset-var or comment rules.
4601
4602 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004603 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4604 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4605 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4606 option httpchk
4607
4608 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004609 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004610 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004611 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004612 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004613 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004614
4615 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4616
4617 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004618
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004620http-check disable-on-404
4621 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004623 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004624 Arguments : none
4625
4626 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4627 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4628 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4629 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4630 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4631 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4632 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4633 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004634 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4635 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4636 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4637
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004638 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004639
4640
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004641http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004642 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4643 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4644 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004645 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004647 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004648
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004649 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004650 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4651
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004652 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4653 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4654 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4655 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4656 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4657 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4658 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4659 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4660 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4661 result is always conclusive.
4662
4663 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4664 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4665 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004666 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4667 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4668 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4669 example 404 with disable-on-404
4670 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4671 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4672 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004673
4674 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4675 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004676 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4677 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4678 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4679 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4680 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4681 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004682
4683 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4684 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004685 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4686 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4687 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4688 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004689 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4690
4691 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4692 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4693 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4694 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4695
4696 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4697 informational message reported in logs if an error
4698 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4699 log-format string.
4700
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004701 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004702 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4703 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004704 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4705 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4706 details on the supported keywords.
4707
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004708 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4709 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4710 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4711 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004712
4713 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4714 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4715 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4716 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4717 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4718
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004719 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4720 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4721 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4722 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4723 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4724 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4725 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004726
4727 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004728 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004729 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4730 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4731 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4732 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4733
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004734 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4735 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004736 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4737 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4738 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4739 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4740 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4741 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4742 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4743 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004744 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4745 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4746 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4747 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4748 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4749 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4750 insensitive on the header names.
4751
4752 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4753 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4754 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4755 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4756 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4757 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004758
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004759 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004760 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004761 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4762 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4763 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4764 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4765 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004766 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004767 trace).
4768
4769 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004770 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004771 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4772 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4773 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4774 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4775 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004776 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004777
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004778 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4779 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4780 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4781 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4782 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4783 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4784
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004785 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4786 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4787 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4788 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4789 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4790 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4791 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4792 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4793
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004794 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4795 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4796 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4797 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4798 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004799
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004800 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4801 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4802
4803 Examples :
4804 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004805 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004806
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004807 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4808 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4809
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004810 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004811 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004812
4813 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004814 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004815
4816 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004817 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004818
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004819 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004820 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004821
4822
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004823http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004824 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4825 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004826 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4827 health checks.
4828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4829 yes | no | yes | yes
4830 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004831 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4832
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004833 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4834 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4835 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4836 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4837 to invent non-standard ones.
4838
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004839 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4840 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4841 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4842 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4843
4844 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4845 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4846 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4847 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004848
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004849 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004850 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4851 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4852 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4853 to add it.
4854
4855 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4856 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4857 to the log-format rules.
4858
4859 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4860 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4861 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004862
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004863 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4864 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4865 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4866 request.
4867
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004868 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4869 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4870 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004871 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4872 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4873 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4874 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004875 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4876 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4877 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4878
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004879 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4880 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004881 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4882 so, it will be ignored.
4883
4884 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4885 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4886 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4887 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4888 configured request authority.
4889
4890 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4891 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004892
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004893 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004894
4895
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004896http-check send-state
4897 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4899 yes | no | yes | yes
4900 Arguments : none
4901
4902 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4903 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4904 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4905 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4906 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4907
4908 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4909 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4910 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4911 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4912 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004913 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4914 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4915 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4916
4917 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4918 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4919 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4920
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004921 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4922 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4923 checked in multiple backends.
4924
4925 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4926 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4927
4928 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4929 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4930 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4931 one fails.
4932
4933 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4934 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4935 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4936
4937 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4938 server's queue.
4939
4940 Example of a header received by the application server :
4941 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4942 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4943
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004944 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4945 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004946
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004947
4948http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004949 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | no | yes | yes
4952
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004953 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004954 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4955 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4956 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4957 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4958 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4959 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4960 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4961 and '-'.
4962
4963 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4964
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004965 Examples :
4966 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004967
4968
4969http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004970 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 yes | no | yes | yes
4973
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004974 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004975 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4976 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4977 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4978 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4979 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4980 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4981 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4982 and '-'.
4983
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004984 Examples :
4985 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004987
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004988http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
4989 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4990 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
4991 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
4992 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
4993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 yes | yes | yes | yes
4995 Arguments :
4996 staus <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
4997 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004998 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 425, 429,
4999 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005000
5001 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5002 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5003 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5004 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5005
5006 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5007 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5008 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5009 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5010
5011 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5012 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5013 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5014 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5015 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5016 chroot is performed.
5017
5018 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5019 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5020 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5021 considered.
5022
5023 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5024 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5025 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5026 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5027 considered as a raw string.
5028
5029 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5030 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5031 "content-type".
5032
5033 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5034 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5035 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5036 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5037 evaluated as a log-format string.
5038
5039 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5040 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5041 argument to "content-type".
5042
5043 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5044 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5045 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5046 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5047
5048 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5049 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5050 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5051 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5052 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5053 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5054 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5055 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5056
5057 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5058 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5059 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5060
5061 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5062 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5063
5064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005065http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005066 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5067
5068 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5069 no | yes | yes | yes
5070
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005071 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5072 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5073 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5074 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5075 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005077 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5078 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005080 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005082 Example:
5083 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5084 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5085 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005087 http-request allow if nagios
5088 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5089 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5090 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005092 Example:
5093 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5094 acl add path /addacl
5095 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005097 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005099 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5100 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005102 Example:
5103 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5104 acl setmap path /setmap
5105 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005107 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005109 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5110 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005112 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5113 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005115http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005117 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5118 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5119 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5120 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5121 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5122 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5123 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5124 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005126http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005128 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5129 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5130 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5131 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5132 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5133 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5134 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5135 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005137http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005139 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5140 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005141
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005143http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005145 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5146 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5147 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5148 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5149 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005150
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005151 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5152 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5153 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5154 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5155 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5156 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5157 instead.
5158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005159 Example:
5160 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5161 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005162
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005163http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005164
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005165 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005167http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5168 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005170 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5171 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5172 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5173 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5174 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5175 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5176 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5177 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5178 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005180 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5181 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5182 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005183 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5184
5185 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5186 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5187 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5188 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005190http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005192 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5193 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5194 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5195 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5196 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5197 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005199http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005200
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005201 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005203http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005205 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5206 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5207 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5208 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5209 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5210 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005211
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005212http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5213http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5214 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5215 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5216 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5217 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005218
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005219 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5220 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5221 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
5222 return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined,
5223 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5224 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5225 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005226 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005227 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005228
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005229http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5230 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5231 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5232 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5233
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005234http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5235
5236 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5237 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5238 pointed by <resolvers>.
5239 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5240 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5241 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5242 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5243 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5244 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5245 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5246 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5247 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5248 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5249 to 0.0.0.0.
5250
5251 Example:
5252 resolvers mydns
5253 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5254 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5255 timeout retry 1s
5256 hold valid 10s
5257 hold nx 3s
5258 hold other 3s
5259 hold obsolete 0s
5260 accepted_payload_size 8192
5261
5262 frontend fe
5263 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5264 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5265 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5266
5267 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5268 # which mean DNS resolution error
5269 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5270
5271 default_backend be
5272
5273 backend b_503
5274 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5275 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5276 # 503 error page to end users
5277
5278 backend be
5279 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5280 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5281 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5282 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5283 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5284
5285 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5286 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5287
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005288http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5289
5290 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5291 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5292 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5293 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005294 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5295 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005296
5297 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005299http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005301 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5302 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5303 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5304 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5305 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005307http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005309 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5310 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5311 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5312 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005314http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5315 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005316
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005317 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005318 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5319 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5320 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5321 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5322 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005323
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005324 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5325 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5326 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5327 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5328 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005329
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005330 Example:
5331 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5332
5333 # applied to:
5334 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5335
5336 # outputs:
5337 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5338
5339 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005340
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005341 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5342
5343 # applied to:
5344 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005345
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005346 # outputs:
5347 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005348
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005349http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5350 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5351
5352 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5353 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5354 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5355 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5356
5357 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5358 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5359 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5360
5361 Example:
5362 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5363 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5364
5365 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5366 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5367
5368 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5369 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5370 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5371 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5372
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005373http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5375
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005376 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5377 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5378 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5379 against.
5380
5381 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5382 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5383 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005384
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005385 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5386 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5387 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5388 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5389 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5390 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5391 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5392 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5393 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005394 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5395 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005396
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005397 Example:
5398 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5399 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005400
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005401 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5402 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005404http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005406
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005407 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5408 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5409 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5410 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005411
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005412 Example:
5413 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005415 # applied to:
5416 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005417
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005418 # outputs:
5419 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005420
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005421http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5422 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5423 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005424 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005425 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5426
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005427 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005428 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5429 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5430 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5431 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005432 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005433 are followed to create the response :
5434
5435 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5436 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5437 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5438 ignored.
5439
5440 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5441 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5442 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5443 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5444 ignored.
5445
5446 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5447 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5448 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5449 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5450 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5451
5452 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5453 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5454 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5455 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5456 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5457 if any, is ignored.
5458
5459 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5460 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5461 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5462 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5463 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5464 as a raw content.
5465
5466 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5467 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5468 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5469 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5470 considered as a raw string.
5471
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005472 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5473 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5474 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5475 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5476
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005477 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5478 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5479 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5480
5481 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5482
5483 Example:
5484 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5485 if { path /ping }
5486
5487 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5488 if { path /favicon.ico }
5489
5490 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5491 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5492 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005494http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5495http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005497 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5498 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5499 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005500
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005501http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5502 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005503
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005504 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5505 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5506 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5507 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005509http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005511 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5512 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5513 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5514 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5515 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005517 Arguments:
5518 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5519 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005521 Example:
5522 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5523 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005525 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5526 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005528http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005530 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5531 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5532 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005534 Arguments:
5535 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5536 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005538 Example:
5539 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5540 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005542 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5543 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5544 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005546http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005548 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5549 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5550 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5551 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5552 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005554 Example:
5555 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5556 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5557 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5558 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5559 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5560 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5561 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5562 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5563 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005565http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005567 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5568 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5569 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5570 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5571 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005573http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5574 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005576 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5577 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5578 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5579 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5580 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5581 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5582 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5583 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5584 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005586http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005588 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5589 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5590 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5591 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5592 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5593 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5594 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005596http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005598 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5599 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5600 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005602http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005604 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5605 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5606 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5607 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5608 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5609 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5610 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5611 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005613http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005615 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5616 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5617 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5618 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5619 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5620 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005622 Example :
5623 # prepend the host name before the path
5624 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005626http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005628 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5629 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5630 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5631 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5632 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005634http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005636 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5637 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5638 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5639 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5640 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5641 values have higher priority.
5642 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5643 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5644 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5645 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5646 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005648http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005650 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5651 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5652 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5653 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5654 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5655 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5656 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005658 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005659
5660 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005661 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5662 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005664http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5665 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5666 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5667 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005668 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5669 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005670
5671 Arguments :
5672 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5673 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005674
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005675 See also "option forwardfor".
5676
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005677 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005678 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5679 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5680
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005681 # After the masking this will track connections
5682 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5683 http-request track-sc0 src
5684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005685 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5686 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5687
5688http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5689
5690 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5691 expression.
5692
5693 Arguments:
5694 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5695 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005696
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005697 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005698 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5699 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5700
5701 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5702 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5703 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5704
5705http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5706
5707 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5708 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5709 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5710 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5711 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5712 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5713 information from the request.
5714
5715 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5716
5717http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5718
5719 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5720 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5721 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5722 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5723 path and the query string.
5724 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5725
5726http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5727
5728 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5729 inline.
5730
5731 Arguments:
5732 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5733 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5734 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5735 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5736 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5737 (request and response)
5738 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5739 processing
5740 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5741 processing
5742 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5743 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5744 and '_'.
5745
5746 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5747 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005748
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005749 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005750 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005752http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5753 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005755 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5756 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5757 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5758 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5759 agent name must be used.
5760
5761 Arguments:
5762 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5763
5764 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5765 configuration.
5766
5767http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5768
5769 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5770 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5771 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5772 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5773 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5774 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5775 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5776 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5777 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5778 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5779 action.
5780 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5781 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5782 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5783 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5784 you fully understand how it works.
5785
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005786http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5787
5788 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5789 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5790 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5791 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5792 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005793 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005794 processing.
5795
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005796 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005797 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5798 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5799 rules evaluation.
5800
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005801http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5802http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5803 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5804 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5805 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5806 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005807
5808 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5809 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5810 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005811 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5812 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5813 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5814 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5815 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5816 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5817 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5818 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5819 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5820 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
5821 For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
5822 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5823 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5824 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5825 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5826 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005827
5828http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5829http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5830http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5831
5832 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5833 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5834 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5835 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5836 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5837 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5838 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5839 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5840 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5841 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5842 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5843 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5844
5845 Arguments :
5846 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5847 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5848 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5849 select which table entry to update the counters.
5850
5851 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5852 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5853 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5854 that table until the session ends.
5855
5856 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5857 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5858 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5859 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5860 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5861 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5862 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5863 useful information.
5864
5865 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5866 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5867 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5868 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5869 checks that make use of it.
5870
5871http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5872
5873 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005874
5875 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005876 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005877
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005878http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5879
5880 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5881 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5882 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5883 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5884 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5885 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5886
5887 Arguments :
5888 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5889
5890 Example:
5891 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005895 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5896 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5897 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005898
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005900http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005901 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5902
5903 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5904 no | yes | yes | yes
5905
5906 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5907 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5908 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5909 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5910 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5911 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5912
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005913 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5914 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005916 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005918 Example:
5919 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005921 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005922
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005923 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5924 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005926 Example:
5927 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005929 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005930
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005931 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5932 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005934 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5935 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005937http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005939 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5940 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5941 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5942 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5943 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5944 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5945 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5946 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005948http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005950 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5951 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5952 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5953 example, or to pass some internal information.
5954 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5955 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5956 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005958http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005960 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5961 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005962
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005963http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005964
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005965 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005967http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005969 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5970 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5971 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5972 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5973 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5974 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5975 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005977 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5978 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5979 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5980 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5981 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005982
5983 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5984 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5985 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5986 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005988http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005990 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5991 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5992 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5993 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5994 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5995 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005997http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005999 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006001http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006003 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6004 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6005 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6006 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6007 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6008 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006009
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006010http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6011http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6012 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6013 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6014 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6015 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006016
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006017 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6018 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6019 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
6020 "http-response return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no
6021 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6022 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6023 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006024 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006025 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006027http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006029 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6030 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6031 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6032 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6033 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6034 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006036http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6037 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006038
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006039 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6040 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006042 Example:
6043 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006045 # applied to:
6046 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006048 # outputs:
6049 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006051 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006053http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6054 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006055
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006056 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006057 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006059 Example:
6060 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006062 # applied to:
6063 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006065 # outputs:
6066 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006067
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006068http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6069 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6070 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006071 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006072 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6073
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006074 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006075 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6076 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
6077 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
6078 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006079 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006080 are followed to create the response :
6081
6082 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6083 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6084 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6085 ignored.
6086
6087 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6088 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
6089 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
6090 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6091 ignored.
6092
6093 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6094 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6095 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
6096 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
6097 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
6098
6099 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6100 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6101 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
6102 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
6103 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
6104 if any, is ignored.
6105
6106 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6107 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6108 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6109 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6110 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6111 as a raw content.
6112
6113 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6114 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6115 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6116 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6117 considered as a raw string.
6118
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006119 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6120 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6121 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6122 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6123
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006124 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6125 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
6126 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
6127
6128 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6129
6130 Example:
6131 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
6132 if { status eq 404 }
6133
6134 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6135 string "This is the end !" \
6136 if { status eq 500 }
6137
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006138http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6139http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006141 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6142 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6143 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006144
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006145http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6146 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006147
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006148 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6149 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6150 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6151 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006153http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006155 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6156 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6157 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6158 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6159 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006161 Arguments:
6162 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006164 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6165 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006167http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006169 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6170 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6171 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006173http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6174
6175 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6176 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6177 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6178 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6179 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6180
6181http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6182
6183 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6184 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6185 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6186 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6187 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6188 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6189 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6190 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6191 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6192
6193http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6194
6195 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6196 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6197 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6198 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6199 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6200 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6201 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6202
6203http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6204
6205 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6206 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6207 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6208 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6209 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6210 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6211 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6212 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6213
6214http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6215 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6216
6217 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6218 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6219 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6220 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006221
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006222 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006223 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6224 http-response set-status 431
6225 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6226 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006228http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006229
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006230 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6231 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6232 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6233 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6234 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6235 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6236 based on some information from the request.
6237
6238 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6239
6240http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6241
6242 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6243 inline.
6244
6245 Arguments:
6246 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6247 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6248 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6249 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6250 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6251 (request and response)
6252 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6253 processing
6254 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6255 processing
6256 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6257 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6258 and '_'.
6259
6260 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6261 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006262
6263 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006264 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006265
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006266http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006267
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006268 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6269 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6270 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6271 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6272 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6273 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6274 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6275 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6276 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6277 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6278 action.
6279 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6280 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6281 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6282 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6283 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006284
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006285http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6286
6287 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6288 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6289 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6290 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6291 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006292 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006293 processing.
6294
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006295 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006296 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6297 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6298 rules evaluation.
6299
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006300http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6301http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6302http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006303
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006304 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6305 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6306 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6307 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6308 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6309 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6310
6311http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6312
6313 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6314 about <var-name>.
6315
6316 Example:
6317 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6318
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006319
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006320http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6321 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6322
6323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6324 yes | no | yes | yes
6325
6326 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006327 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6328 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6329 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006330
6331 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6332
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006333 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6334 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6335 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6336 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6337 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6338 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6339 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6340 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6341 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6342 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006343
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006344 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6345 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6346 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6347 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6348 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6349 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6350 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6351 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006352
6353 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6354 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6355 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6356 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6357 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6358 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6359 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6360 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006361 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006362 downsides of rare connection failures.
6363
6364 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6365 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6366 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6367 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6368 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6369 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006370 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006371 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6372 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6373 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6374 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6375 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6376
6377 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006378 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6379 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6380 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006381
6382 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006383 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006384
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006385 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6386 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006387
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006388 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006389
6390 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6391 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6392 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6393
6394 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6395
6396
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006397http-send-name-header [<header>]
6398 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6400 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006401 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006402 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6403
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006404 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6405 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6406 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6407 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6408 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6409 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6410 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6411 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6412 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6413 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6414 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6415 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6416 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6417 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6418 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6419 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006420
6421 See also : "server"
6422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006423id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006424 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6426 no | yes | yes | yes
6427 Arguments : none
6428
6429 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6430 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6431 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006432
6433
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006434ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6435 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6436 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006437 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006438
6439 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6440 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6441 and running).
6442
6443 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6444 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6445 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006446 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006447 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6448
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006449 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6450 "unless" condition is met.
6451
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006452 Example:
6453 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6454 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6455 ignore-persist if url_static
6456
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006457 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6458
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006459load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6460 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6461 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6462 yes | no | yes | yes
6463
6464 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6465 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6466 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006467 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006468 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6469 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6470 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6471 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6472
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006473 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006474 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006475 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006476
6477 Arguments:
6478 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6479 named "server-state-file".
6480
6481 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6482 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6483 name is used as a file name.
6484
6485 none don't load any stat for this backend
6486
6487 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006488 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6489 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6490 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006491 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006492 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006493
6494 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6495 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6496
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006497 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006498
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006499 global
6500 stats socket /tmp/socket
6501 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006502
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006503 defaults
6504 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006505
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006506 backend bk
6507 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6508 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006509
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006510
6511 Then one can run :
6512
6513 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6514
6515 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6516
6517 1
6518 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6519 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6520 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6521
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006522 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006523
6524 global
6525 stats socket /tmp/socket
6526 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6527
6528 defaults
6529 load-server-state-from-file local
6530
6531 backend bk
6532 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6533 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6534
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006535
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006536 Then one can run :
6537
6538 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6539
6540 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6541
6542 1
6543 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6544 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6545 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6546
6547 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6548 "show servers state"
6549
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006550
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006551log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006552log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6553 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006554no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006555 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6557 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006558
6559 Prefix :
6560 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6561 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6562 prefix does not allow arguments.
6563
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006564 Arguments :
6565 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6566 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6567 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6568 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6569 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6570 parameter.
6571
6572 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6573 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6574
6575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6576 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6577 standard syslog port).
6578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6580 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6581 standard syslog port).
6582
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6585 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006586 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006587
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006588 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6589 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6590 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6591 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6592 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6593 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6594 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6595 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6596 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6597 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6598 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6599 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6600 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6601 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6602 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6603 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006604 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6605 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006606
6607 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6608 and "fd@2", see above.
6609
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006610 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6611 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6612 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6613 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6614 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6615 having the logs instantly available.
6616
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006617 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6618 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006619
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006620 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6621 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6622 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6623 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6624 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6625 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6626 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6627 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6628 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6629 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006630 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006631
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006632 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6633 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6634 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6635 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6636 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6637
6638 <sample_size>
6639 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6640 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6641 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6642 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6643 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6644
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006645 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6646 one of the following :
6647
6648 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6649 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6650
6651 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6652 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6653
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006654 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6655 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6656 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6657 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6658 systemd logger consumes.
6659
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006660 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6661 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6662 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6663 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6664
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006665 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6666
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006667 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6668 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6669 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6670
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006671 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6672 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6673 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6674 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006675
6676 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6677 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6678 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006679 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6680 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6681 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6682 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6683 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006684
6685 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6686
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006687 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6688 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6689 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006690
6691 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6692 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6693 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6694 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6695
6696 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6697 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006698
6699 Example :
6700 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006701 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6702 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6703 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006704 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6705 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006706 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006708
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006709log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006710 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6711 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006713
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006714 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6715 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6716 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6717 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6718 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006719
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006720 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6721 "option httplog" directives.
6722
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006723log-format-sd <string>
6724 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6726 yes | yes | yes | no
6727
6728 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6729 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6730 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6731 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6732 which covers the log format string in depth.
6733
6734 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6735 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6736
6737 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6738 log format to "rfc5424".
6739
6740 Example :
6741 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6742
6743
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006744log-tag <string>
6745 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6746 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6747 yes | yes | yes | yes
6748
6749 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6750 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6751 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6752 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6753 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6754 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6755 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6756 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6757 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006758
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006759max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6760 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6762 yes | no | yes | yes
6763
6764 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6765 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6766 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6767 servers.
6768
6769 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6770 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6771 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6772 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6773 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006774 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006775 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6776 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6777 picking a different server.
6778
6779 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6780 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6781 even if they have to be queued.
6782
6783 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6784 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6785
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006786max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6787 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6788 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6789 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006790
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006791maxconn <conns>
6792 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6794 yes | yes | yes | no
6795 Arguments :
6796 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6797 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6798 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6799 closes.
6800
6801 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6802 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6803 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6804 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006805 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6806 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6807 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6808 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006809
6810 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6811 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6812 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6813
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006814 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6815 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006817 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6818
6819
6820mode { tcp|http|health }
6821 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6823 yes | yes | yes | yes
6824 Arguments :
6825 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6826 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6827 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6828 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6829
6830 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6831 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6832 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6833 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6834 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6835
6836 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006837 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6838 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6839 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6840 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6841 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6842 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6843 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006844
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006845 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6846 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6847 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006848
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006849 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006850 defaults http_instances
6851 mode http
6852
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006853 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006854
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006855
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006856monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006857 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6859 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006860 Arguments :
6861 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6862 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006863 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006864 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6865 backend and its backup.
6866
6867 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6868 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6869 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6870 servers in a list of backends.
6871
6872 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6873 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6874 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6875 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6876 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6877 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6878 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006879 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6880 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006881
6882 Example:
6883 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006884 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006885 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6886 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6887 monitor-uri /site_alive
6888 monitor fail if site_dead
6889
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006890 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006891
6892
6893monitor-net <source>
6894 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6896 yes | yes | yes | no
6897 Arguments :
6898 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6899 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6900 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6901 followed by a mask.
6902
6903 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6904 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006905 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006906 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6907
6908 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6909 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6910 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6911 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006912 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6913 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6914 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006915
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006916 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6917 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6918 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6919 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6920 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6921 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006922
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006923 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6924 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006925
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006926 Example :
6927 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6928 frontend www
6929 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6930
6931 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6932
6933
6934monitor-uri <uri>
6935 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6937 yes | yes | yes | no
6938 Arguments :
6939 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6940 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6941
6942 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6943 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6944 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6945 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6946 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6947 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6948 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6949 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6950
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006951 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006952 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6953 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6954 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6955 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6956 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6957 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006958
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006959 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6960 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6961 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6962 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6963
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006964 Example :
6965 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6966 frontend www
6967 mode http
6968 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6969
6970 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006972
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006973option abortonclose
6974no option abortonclose
6975 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6977 yes | no | yes | yes
6978 Arguments : none
6979
6980 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6981 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6982 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6983 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006984 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006985 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6986 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6987 encountered while delivering the response.
6988
6989 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6990 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6991 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6992 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6993 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6994 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006995 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006996 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006997 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006998 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6999 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7000 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7001
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007002 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7003 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007004 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7005 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7006 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7007 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7008 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7009 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007010 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007011
7012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7014
7015 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7016
7017
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007018option accept-invalid-http-request
7019no option accept-invalid-http-request
7020 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7022 yes | yes | yes | no
7023 Arguments : none
7024
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007025 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007026 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007027 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007028 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7029 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7030 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7031 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7032 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007033 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7034 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7035 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7036 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007037 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007038 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007039 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7040 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7041 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007042
7043 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7044 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7045 been confirmed.
7046
7047 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7048 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007049 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7050 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007051 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7052
7053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7055
7056 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7057 stats socket.
7058
7059
7060option accept-invalid-http-response
7061no option accept-invalid-http-response
7062 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7064 yes | no | yes | yes
7065 Arguments : none
7066
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007067 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007068 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007069 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007070 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7071 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7072 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7073 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7074 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007075 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7076 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7077 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007078
7079 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7080 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7081 been confirmed.
7082
7083 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7084 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7085 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7086 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7087
7088 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7089 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7090
7091 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7092 stats socket.
7093
7094
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007095option allbackups
7096no option allbackups
7097 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7099 yes | no | yes | yes
7100 Arguments : none
7101
7102 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7103 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7104 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7105 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7106 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7107 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7108 order between the backup servers anymore.
7109
7110 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7111 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7112
7113 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7114 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7115
7116
7117option checkcache
7118no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007119 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7121 yes | no | yes | yes
7122 Arguments : none
7123
7124 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7125 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007126 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007127 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7128 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007129 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007130
7131 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007132 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007133 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007134 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7135 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007136 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007137 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007138 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7139 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007140 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007141 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7142 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007143 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007144 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7145 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7146 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7147 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7148 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7149 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7150 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7151 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7152 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7153
7154 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007155 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7156 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7157 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7158 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007159
7160 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7161 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007162 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007163 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007164
7165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7167
7168
7169option clitcpka
7170no option clitcpka
7171 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7173 yes | yes | yes | no
7174 Arguments : none
7175
7176 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7177 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007178 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007179 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7180
7181 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7182 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7183 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7184 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7185
7186 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7187 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7188 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7189 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7190 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7191
7192 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7193
7194 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7195 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7196 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7197
7198 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7199 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7200
7201 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7202
7203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007204option contstats
7205 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7207 yes | yes | yes | no
7208 Arguments : none
7209
7210 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7211 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7212 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7213 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007214 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7215 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7216 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7217 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7218 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007219
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007220option disable-h2-upgrade
7221no option disable-h2-upgrade
7222 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7223 connection.
7224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7225 yes | yes | yes | no
7226 Arguments : none
7227
7228 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7229 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7230 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7231 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7232 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7233 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7234 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7235 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7236
7237 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7238 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007239
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007240option dontlog-normal
7241no option dontlog-normal
7242 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7244 yes | yes | yes | no
7245 Arguments : none
7246
7247 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7248 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7249 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7250 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7251 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7252 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7253 logged.
7254
7255 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7256 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7257 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007259 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007260 logging.
7261
7262
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007263option dontlognull
7264no option dontlognull
7265 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7267 yes | yes | yes | no
7268 Arguments : none
7269
7270 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7271 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7272 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7273 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7274 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7275 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007276 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7277 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7278 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007279
7280 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007281 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007282 would not be logged.
7283
7284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7286
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007287 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7288 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007289
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007290
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007291option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007292 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7294 yes | yes | yes | yes
7295 Arguments :
7296 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7297 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007298 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007299 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007300
7301 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7302 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7303 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7304 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7305 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7306 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7307 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007308 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7309 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7310 possible that the client has already brought one.
7311
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007312 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007313 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007314 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007315 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007316 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007317 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007318
7319 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7320 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7321 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7322 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7323 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7324 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7325 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7326
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007327 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7328 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7329 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7330 are under the control of the end-user.
7331
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007332 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007333 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7334 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007335 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7336 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7337 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007338
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007339 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007340 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7341 frontend www
7342 mode http
7343 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7344
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007345 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7346 backend www
7347 mode http
7348 option forwardfor header X-Client
7349
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007350 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007351 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007352
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007353
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007354option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7355no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7356 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7358 yes | yes | yes | no
7359 Arguments : none
7360
7361 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7362 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7363 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7364 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7365 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7366 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7367 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7368
7369 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7370 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7371 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7372 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7373 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7374 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7375 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7376 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7377 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7378 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7379
7380 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7381
7382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7384
7385 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7386 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7387
7388
7389option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7390no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7391 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7393 yes | no | yes | yes
7394 Arguments : none
7395
7396 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7397 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7398 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7399 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7400 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7401 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7402 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7403
7404 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7405 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7406 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7407 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7408 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7409 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7410 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7411 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7412 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7413 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7414
7415 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7416
7417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7419
7420 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7421 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7422
7423
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007424option http-buffer-request
7425no option http-buffer-request
7426 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7428 yes | yes | yes | yes
7429 Arguments : none
7430
7431 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7432 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7433 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7434 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7435 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7436 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007437 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7438 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7439 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7440 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007441
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007442 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007443
7444
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007445option http-ignore-probes
7446no option http-ignore-probes
7447 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7449 yes | yes | yes | no
7450 Arguments : none
7451
7452 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7453 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7454 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7455 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7456 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7457 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7458 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7459 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7460 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007461 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7462 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007463 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7464
7465 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7466 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7467 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7468 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7469 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7470 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7471 are often the only way to detect them.
7472
7473 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7474 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7475
7476 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7477
7478
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007479option http-keep-alive
7480no option http-keep-alive
7481 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7483 yes | yes | yes | yes
7484 Arguments : none
7485
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007486 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7487 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007488 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7489 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007490 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7491 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7492 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007493
7494 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7495 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007496 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7497 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7498 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7499 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7500 situations where this option may be useful :
7501
7502 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007503 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007504
7505 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7506 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7507
7508 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7509 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7510 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7511 request.
7512
7513 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7514 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007515 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7516 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7517 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007518
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007519 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7520 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7521 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7522 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7523 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7524 not set.
7525
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007526 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7527 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7528 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007529
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007530 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007531 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007532 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007533
7534
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007535option http-no-delay
7536no option http-no-delay
7537 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7539 yes | yes | yes | yes
7540 Arguments : none
7541
7542 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7543 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7544 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7545 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7546 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7547 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7548 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7549 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7550 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7551 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7552 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7553 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7554 affected.
7555
7556 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7557 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7558 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7559 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7560 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7561 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7562 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7563 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7564 latency environments.
7565
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007566 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7567
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007568
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007569option http-pretend-keepalive
7570no option http-pretend-keepalive
7571 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007573 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007574 Arguments : none
7575
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007576 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007577 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7578 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7579 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7580 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7581 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7582 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7583 consider the response complete.
7584
7585 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7586 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7587 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7588 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007589 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007590 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7591
7592 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7593 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7594 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7595 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7596 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7597 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7598 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7599
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007600 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7601 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7602 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7603 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7604 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7605 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007606
7607 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7608 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7609
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007610 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007611 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007612
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007613
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007614option http-server-close
7615no option http-server-close
7616 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7618 yes | yes | yes | yes
7619 Arguments : none
7620
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007621 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7622 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7623 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7624 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007625 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7626 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7627 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7628 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7629 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7630 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7631 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7632 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7633 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7634 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7635 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007636
7637 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7638 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7639 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7640 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007641 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7642 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007643
7644 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7645 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007646 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7647 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7648 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007649
7650 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7651 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7652
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007653 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7654 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007655
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007656option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007657no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007658 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7660 yes | yes | yes | no
7661 Arguments : none
7662
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007663 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007664 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7665 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7666 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7667 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7668 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7669 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7670
7671 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7672 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007673 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7674 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7675 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007676
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007677 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7678 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7679 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7680 front of an existing proxy.
7681
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007682 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7683
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007684 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007685
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007686option httpchk
7687option httpchk <uri>
7688option httpchk <method> <uri>
7689option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007690 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7692 yes | no | yes | yes
7693 Arguments :
7694 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7695 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7696 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7697 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7698 ones.
7699
7700 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7701 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7702 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7703
7704 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7705 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7706 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007707 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007708
7709 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7710 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7711 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7712 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7713 the lack of any response.
7714
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007715 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7716 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7717 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7718 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7719
7720 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7721 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7722 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007723
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007724 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7725 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007726 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7727 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7728 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007729
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007730 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7731 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7732 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7733 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7734
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007735 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007736 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7737 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7738 backend https_relay
7739 mode tcp
7740 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7741 http-check send hdr Host www
7742 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007743
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007744 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7745 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7746 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007747
7748
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007749option httpclose
7750no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007751 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7753 yes | yes | yes | yes
7754 Arguments : none
7755
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007756 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7757 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7758 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7759 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007760 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007761
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007762 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7763 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007764 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007765 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7766 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007767
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007768 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7769 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7770 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007771
7772 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7773 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007774 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7775 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7776 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007777
7778 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7779 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7780
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007781 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007782
7783
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007784option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007785 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007787 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007788 Arguments :
7789 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7790 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7791 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007792 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007793 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007794
7795 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7796 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7797 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7798 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7799 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7800 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7801 ports.
7802
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007803 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7804 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007805
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007806 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007808 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007809
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007810
7811option http_proxy
7812no option http_proxy
7813 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7815 yes | yes | yes | yes
7816 Arguments : none
7817
7818 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7819 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7820 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7821 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7822 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7823
7824 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7825 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007826 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7827 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007828
7829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7831
7832 Example :
7833 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7834 backend direct_forward
7835 option httpclose
7836 option http_proxy
7837
7838 See also : "option httpclose"
7839
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007840
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007841option independent-streams
7842no option independent-streams
7843 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7845 yes | yes | yes | yes
7846 Arguments : none
7847
7848 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7849 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7850 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7851 receive data or not.
7852
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007853 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007854 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7855 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7856 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7857 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7858 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7859 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7860 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7861 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7862 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7863 socket buffers.
7864
7865 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7866 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7867 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7868 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7869 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7870
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007871 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007872
7873
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007874option ldap-check
7875 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7877 yes | no | yes | yes
7878 Arguments : none
7879
7880 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7881 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7882 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7883 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7884
7885 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7886 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7887
7888 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7889 configure it.
7890
7891 Example :
7892 option ldap-check
7893
7894 See also : "option httpchk"
7895
7896
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007897option external-check
7898 Use external processes for server health checks
7899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7900 yes | no | yes | yes
7901
7902 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7903 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7904 command".
7905
7906 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7907
7908 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7909
7910
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007911option log-health-checks
7912no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007913 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7915 yes | no | yes | yes
7916 Arguments : none
7917
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007918 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7919 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7920 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007921
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007922 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7923 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7924 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7925 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7926 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7927
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007928 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007929 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007930
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007931 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7932 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7933 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007934
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007935
7936option log-separate-errors
7937no option log-separate-errors
7938 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7940 yes | yes | yes | no
7941 Arguments : none
7942
7943 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7944 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7945 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7946 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7947 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7948 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7949 provides very important information.
7950
7951 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7952 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7953 error logs.
7954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007955 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007956 logging.
7957
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007958
7959option logasap
7960no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007961 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 yes | yes | yes | no
7964 Arguments : none
7965
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007966 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7967 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7968 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7969 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7970
7971 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7972 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7973 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7974 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7975 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007976 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007977 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7978 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7979 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7980 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007981 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007982
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007983 Examples :
7984 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7985 mode http
7986 option httplog
7987 option logasap
7988 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7989
7990 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7991 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7992 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7993 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007995 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007996 logging.
7997
7998
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02007999option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008000 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8002 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008003 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008004 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8005 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008006 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8007 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008008
8009 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8010 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008011 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008012 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8013 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8014 in the MySQL table, like this :
8015
8016 USE mysql;
8017 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8018 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8019
8020 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008021 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008022 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8023 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8024 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8025 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8026 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8027 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8028 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8029
8030 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8031 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008032
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008033 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008034
8035 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8036 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8037 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8038 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008039 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8040 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008041
8042 See also: "option httpchk"
8043
8044
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008045option nolinger
8046no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008047 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8049 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008050 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008051
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008052 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008053 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8054 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8055 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8056 connections.
8057
8058 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8059 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8060 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8061 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8062 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8063 this too.
8064
8065 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8066 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8067 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8068
8069 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8070 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8071 for servers.
8072
8073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8075
8076
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008077option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8078 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8080 yes | yes | yes | yes
8081 Arguments :
8082 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8083 matching <network>
8084 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8085 header name.
8086
8087 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8088 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8089 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8090 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8091 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8092 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8093 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8094 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8095 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8096 possible that the client has already brought one.
8097
8098 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8099 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8100 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8101 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8102 header and requires different one.
8103
8104 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8105 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8106 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8107 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8108 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8109 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8110 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8111
8112 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8113 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8114 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8115 both are defined.
8116
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008117 Examples :
8118 # Original Destination address
8119 frontend www
8120 mode http
8121 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8122
8123 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8124 backend www
8125 mode http
8126 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8127
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008128 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008129
8130
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008131option persist
8132no option persist
8133 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8135 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008136 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008137
8138 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8139 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8140 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8141 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8142 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8143 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8144 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8145 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8146 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8147 redirected to another valid server.
8148
8149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8151
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008152 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008153
8154
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008155option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8156 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8158 yes | no | yes | yes
8159 Arguments :
8160 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8161 PostgreSQL server.
8162
8163 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8164 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8165 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8166 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8167
8168 See also: "option httpchk"
8169
8170
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008171option prefer-last-server
8172no option prefer-last-server
8173 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8175 yes | no | yes | yes
8176 Arguments : none
8177
8178 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8179 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8180 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8181 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8182 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8183 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8184 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8185 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8186 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008187 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8188 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008189 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8190 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8191 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008192 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8193 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8194 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008195
8196 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8197 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8198
8199 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8200
8201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008202option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008203option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008204no option redispatch
8205 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8207 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008208 Arguments :
8209 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8210 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8211 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008212 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008213 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008214 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008215 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8216 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8217 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008219
8220 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8221 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8222 be able to access the service anymore.
8223
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008224 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8225 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008226
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008227 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8228 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8229 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8230 following order:
8231
8232 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8233
8234 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8235 list, or
8236
8237 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8238
8239 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8240 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8241
8242 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8243 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8244 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8245 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8246
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008247 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008248 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8249 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008251 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8252 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8253
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008254 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008255
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008256
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008257option redis-check
8258 Use redis health checks for server testing
8259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8260 yes | no | yes | yes
8261 Arguments : none
8262
8263 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8264 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8265 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8266 find the "+PONG" response message.
8267
8268 Example :
8269 option redis-check
8270
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008271 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008272
8273
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008274option smtpchk
8275option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8276 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8278 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008279 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008280 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008281 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008282 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8283
8284 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8285 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8286 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8287
8288 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8289 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8290 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8291 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8292 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8293 dead server.
8294
8295 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8296 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008297 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008298 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8299
8300 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8301 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8302 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8303 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008304 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008305
8306 Example :
8307 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8308
8309 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8310
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008312option socket-stats
8313no option socket-stats
8314
8315 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8317 yes | yes | yes | no
8318
8319 Arguments : none
8320
8321
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008322option splice-auto
8323no option splice-auto
8324 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8326 yes | yes | yes | yes
8327 Arguments : none
8328
8329 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8330 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008331 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008332 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008333 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008334 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8335 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8336 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8337 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8338
8339 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8340 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8341 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8342 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8343 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8344 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8345 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8346 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8347 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8348 keyword.
8349
8350 Example :
8351 option splice-auto
8352
8353 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8354 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8355
8356 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8357 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8358
8359
8360option splice-request
8361no option splice-request
8362 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8364 yes | yes | yes | yes
8365 Arguments : none
8366
8367 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008368 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008369 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8370 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8371 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8372 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8373
8374 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8375
8376 Example :
8377 option splice-request
8378
8379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8381
8382 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8383 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8384
8385
8386option splice-response
8387no option splice-response
8388 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8390 yes | yes | yes | yes
8391 Arguments : none
8392
8393 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008394 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008395 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8396 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8397 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8398 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8399
8400 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8401
8402 Example :
8403 option splice-response
8404
8405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8407
8408 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8409 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8410
8411
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008412option spop-check
8413 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8415 no | no | no | yes
8416 Arguments : none
8417
8418 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8419 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8420 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8421 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8422
8423 Example :
8424 option spop-check
8425
8426 See also : "option httpchk"
8427
8428
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008429option srvtcpka
8430no option srvtcpka
8431 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8433 yes | no | yes | yes
8434 Arguments : none
8435
8436 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8437 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008438 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008439 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8440
8441 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8442 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8443 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8444 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8445
8446 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8447 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8448 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8449 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8450 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8451
8452 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8453
8454 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8455 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8456 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8457
8458 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8459 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8460
8461 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8462
8463
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008464option ssl-hello-chk
8465 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8467 yes | no | yes | yes
8468 Arguments : none
8469
8470 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8471 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8472 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8473 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8474 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8475 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8476 hello message.
8477
8478 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8479 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8480 messages, which is appreciable.
8481
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008482 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8483 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8484 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008485
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008486 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8487
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008488
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008489option tcp-check
8490 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8491 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8492 yes | no | yes | yes
8493
8494 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8495 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8496
8497 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8498 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8499 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8500
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008501 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008502 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8503 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8504 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8505 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8506 only.
8507
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008508 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008509 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8510 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8511 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8512 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8513
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008514 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008515 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8516 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008517 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008518 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8519 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8520 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8521 the respective protocols.
8522 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008523 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008524
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008525 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008526
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008527 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8528 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8529 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8530 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008531
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008532 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8533 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8534 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008535
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008536
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008537 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008538 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008539 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008540 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008541
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008542 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008543 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008544 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008545
8546 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8547 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008548 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008549 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008550 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008551 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008552 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008553 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008554 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8555 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008556 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008557 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8558 tcp-check expect string +OK
8559
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008560 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008561 (send many headers before analyzing)
8562 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008563 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008564 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8565 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8566 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8567 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008568 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008569
8570
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008571 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008572
8573
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008574option tcp-smart-accept
8575no option tcp-smart-accept
8576 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8578 yes | yes | yes | no
8579 Arguments : none
8580
8581 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8582 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8583 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8584 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8585 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8586 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8587
8588 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8589 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8590 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8591 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8592
8593 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8594 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8595 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008596 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008597
8598 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8599 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8600 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8601
8602 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8603 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8604 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8605
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008606 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8607
8608
8609option tcp-smart-connect
8610no option tcp-smart-connect
8611 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8613 yes | no | yes | yes
8614 Arguments : none
8615
8616 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8617 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8618 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8619 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8620 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8621
8622 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8623 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8624 complex.
8625
8626 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8627 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8628 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8629
8630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8632
8633 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8634
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008635
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008636option tcpka
8637 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8639 yes | yes | yes | yes
8640 Arguments : none
8641
8642 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8643 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008644 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008645 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8646
8647 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8648 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8649 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8650 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8651
8652 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8653 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8654 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8655 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8656 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8657
8658 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8659
8660 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8661 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8662 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8663 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8664 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8665 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8666 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8667 backends.
8668
8669 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8670
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008671
8672option tcplog
8673 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008675 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008676 Arguments : none
8677
8678 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8679 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8680 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8681 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8682 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8683 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8684 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8685 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8686
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008687 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008689 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008690
8691
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008692option transparent
8693no option transparent
8694 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008696 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008697 Arguments : none
8698
8699 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8700 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8701 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8702 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8703 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8704 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8705 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8706 appropriate server.
8707
8708 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8709 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8710
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008711 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008712 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008713
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008714
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008715external-check command <command>
8716 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8718 yes | no | yes | yes
8719
8720 Arguments :
8721 <command> is the external command to run
8722
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008723 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8724
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008725 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008726
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008727 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8728 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8729 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8730 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8731 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8732 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008733
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008734 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8735
8736 Environment variables :
8737 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8738 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8739
8740 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8741
8742 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8743
8744 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8745 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8746 for a UNIX socket).
8747
8748 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8749
8750 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8751
8752 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8753
8754 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8755
8756 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8757
8758 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8759 socket).
8760
8761 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8762 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8763
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008764 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8765
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008766 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8767 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8768 failed.
8769
8770 Example :
8771 external-check command /bin/true
8772
8773 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8774
8775
8776external-check path <path>
8777 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8779 yes | no | yes | yes
8780
8781 Arguments :
8782 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8783
8784 The default path is "".
8785
8786 Example :
8787 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8788
8789 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8790 "external-check command"
8791
8792
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008793persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008794persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008795 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8797 yes | no | yes | yes
8798 Arguments :
8799 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008800 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8801 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008802
8803 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8804 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008805 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008806 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8807 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8808 forwarded to this server.
8809
8810 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8811 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8812 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008813 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008814 a single "listen" section.
8815
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008816 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8817 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8818 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8819
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008820 Example :
8821 listen tse-farm
8822 bind :3389
8823 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8824 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8825 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8826 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8827 persist rdp-cookie
8828 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008829 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008830 balance rdp-cookie
8831 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8832 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8833
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008834 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8835 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008836
8837
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008838rate-limit sessions <rate>
8839 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8841 yes | yes | yes | no
8842 Arguments :
8843 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8844 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8845
8846 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8847 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8848 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8849 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8850 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8851 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8852
8853 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8854 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8855 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8856 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8857
8858 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8859 listen smtp
8860 mode tcp
8861 bind :25
8862 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008863 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008864
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008865 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8866 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8867 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008868
8869 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8870
8871
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008872redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8873redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8874redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008875 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8877 no | yes | yes | yes
8878
8879 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008880 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008881
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008882 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008883 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008884 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8885 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8886 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008887
8888 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8889 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8890 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8891 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8892 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008893 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8894 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8895 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8896 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008897
8898 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8899 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8900 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8901 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8902 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8903 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008904 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008905 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008906 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8907 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8908 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008909
8910 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008911 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8912 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8913 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008914 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008915 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8916 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8917 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8918 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008919
8920 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008921 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008922
8923 - "drop-query"
8924 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8925 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8926 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8927 with a location-type redirect.
8928
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008929 - "append-slash"
8930 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8931 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8932 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8933 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8934
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008935 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8936 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8937 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8938 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8939 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8940 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8941 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8942
8943 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8944 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8945 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8946 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8947 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8948 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8949 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008950
8951 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8952 acl clear dst_port 80
8953 acl secure dst_port 8080
8954 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008955 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008956 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008957 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8958
8959 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008960 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8961 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8962 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008963 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008964
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008965 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8966 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8967 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8968
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008969 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008970 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008971
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008972 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008973 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8974 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8975 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008977 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008978
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008979
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008980retries <value>
8981 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8983 yes | no | yes | yes
8984 Arguments :
8985 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8986 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8987 default value is 3.
8988
8989 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8990 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8991 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8992
8993 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008994 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8995 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008996
8997 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8998 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8999
9000 See also : "option redispatch"
9001
9002
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009003retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009004 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9005 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9006 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9008 yes | no | yes | yes
9009 Arguments :
9010 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9011 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9012 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9013 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9014
9015 none never retry
9016
9017 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9018 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9019
9020 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9021 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9022 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9023 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9024 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9025 processing the request.
9026
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009027 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9028 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9029 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9030 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9031 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9032 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9033 overflow attack for example).
9034
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009035 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9036 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9037 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9038 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9039 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9040 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9041 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9042 amplify denial of service attacks.
9043
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009044 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9045 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9046 considered to be safe to retry.
9047
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009048 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9049 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9050 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9051 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9052
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009053 all-retryable-errors
9054 retry request for any error that are considered
9055 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9056 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9057 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9058
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009059 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9060 not cumulative.
9061
9062 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9063 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9064 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9065 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9066
9067 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9068 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9069 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9070 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9071 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9072 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9073 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9074 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9075 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9076 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9077 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9078 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9079
9080 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9081 should not use this directive.
9082
9083 The default is "conn-failure".
9084
9085 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9086
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009087server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009088 Declare a server in a backend
9089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9090 no | no | yes | yes
9091 Arguments :
9092 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009093 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009094 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009095
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009096 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9097 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9098 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9099 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009100 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9101 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9102 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9103 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9104 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009105 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9106 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9107 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9108 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9109 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9110 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9111 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009112 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009113 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9114 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9115 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9116 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9117 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9118 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009119 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9120 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009121 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9122 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009123
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009124 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009125 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9126 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9127 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9128 adding this value to the client's port.
9129
9130 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9131 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009132 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009133
9134 Examples :
9135 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9136 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009137 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009138 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9139 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9140 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009141
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009142 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9143 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9144 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9145 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9146 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9147
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009148 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9149 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009150
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009151server-state-file-name [<file>]
9152 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9153 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9154 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9155 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9156 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9157 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9158
9159 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9160 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9161
9162 global
9163 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9164
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009165 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009166 load-server-state-from-file
9167
9168 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9169 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009170
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009171server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9172 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9173 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9175 no | no | yes | yes
9176
9177 Arguments:
9178 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9179
9180 <num | range>
9181 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9182 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9183 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9184 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9185
9186 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9187
9188 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9189
9190 <params*>
9191 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9192 keyword.
9193
9194 Examples:
9195 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9196 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9197 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9198
9199 # or
9200 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9201
9202 # would be equivalent to:
9203 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9204 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9205 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9206
9207
9208
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009209source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009210source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009211source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009212 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9214 yes | no | yes | yes
9215 Arguments :
9216 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9217 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009218
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009219 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009220 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9221 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9222 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9223 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9224 supported prefixes are :
9225 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9226 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9227 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009228 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009229 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9230 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009231
9232 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9233 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009234 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9235 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9236 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009237
9238 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9239 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9240 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9241 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9242 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9243 <addr>.
9244
9245 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9246 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9247 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9248 port.
9249
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009250 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9251 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9252 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9253 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009254 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009255 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9256 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9257 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9258 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9259 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9260 HTTP header.
9261
9262 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9263 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009264 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009265 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9266 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9267 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9268 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9269 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9270 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9271 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9272
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009273 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9274 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9275 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9276 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9277 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9278 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9279
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009280 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9281 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9282 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9283 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9284
9285 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9286 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9287 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9288 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9289 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9290 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9291
9292 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9293 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9294 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9295 there are two methods :
9296
9297 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9298 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9299 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9300 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9301 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9302 of the client ranges may be used.
9303
9304 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9305 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9306 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9307 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9308 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9309 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9310 same session.
9311
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009312 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9313 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9314 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009315 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009316
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009317 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9318
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009319 Examples :
9320 backend private
9321 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9322 source 192.168.1.200
9323
9324 backend transparent_ssl1
9325 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9326 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9327
9328 backend transparent_ssl2
9329 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9330 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9331 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9332
9333 backend transparent_ssl3
9334 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9335 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9336 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9337
9338 backend transparent_smtp
9339 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9340 # with Tproxy version 4.
9341 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9342
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009343 backend transparent_http
9344 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9345 # proxy.
9346 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009348 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009349 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9350
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009351
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009352stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9353 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009355 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009356
9357 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9358 matched.
9359
9360 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9361 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9362
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009363 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9364 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009365 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009366
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009367 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9368 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9369 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9370 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009371
9372 Example :
9373 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9374 backend stats_localhost
9375 stats enable
9376 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9377
9378 Example :
9379 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9380 backend stats_auth
9381 stats enable
9382 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9383 stats admin if TRUE
9384
9385 Example :
9386 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9387 userlist stats-auth
9388 group admin users admin
9389 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9390 group readonly users haproxy
9391 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9392
9393 backend stats_auth
9394 stats enable
9395 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9396 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9397 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9398 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9399
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009400 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9401 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9402 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009403
9404
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009405stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9406 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009408 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009409 Arguments :
9410 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9411
9412 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9413
9414 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9415 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9416 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9417 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9418 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9419 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9420
9421 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9422 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9423 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009424 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009425
9426 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9427 report using "stats scope".
9428
9429 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9430 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9431 unobvious parameters.
9432
9433 Example :
9434 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9435 backend public_www
9436 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9437 stats enable
9438 stats hide-version
9439 stats scope .
9440 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009441 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009442 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9443 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9444
9445 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9446 backend private_monitoring
9447 stats enable
9448 stats uri /admin?stats
9449 stats refresh 5s
9450
9451 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9452
9453
9454stats enable
9455 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009457 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009458 Arguments : none
9459
9460 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9461 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9462 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9463 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9464 - stats auth : no authentication
9465 - stats scope : no restriction
9466
9467 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9468 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9469 unobvious parameters.
9470
9471 Example :
9472 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9473 backend public_www
9474 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9475 stats enable
9476 stats hide-version
9477 stats scope .
9478 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009479 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009480 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9481 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9482
9483 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9484 backend private_monitoring
9485 stats enable
9486 stats uri /admin?stats
9487 stats refresh 5s
9488
9489 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9490
9491
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009492stats hide-version
9493 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009495 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009496 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009497
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009498 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9499 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9500 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9501 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9502 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9503 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009505 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9506 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9507 unobvious parameters.
9508
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009509 Example :
9510 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9511 backend public_www
9512 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009513 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009514 stats hide-version
9515 stats scope .
9516 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009517 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009518 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9519 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009520
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009521 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9522 backend private_monitoring
9523 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009524 stats uri /admin?stats
9525 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009526
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009527 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009528
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009529
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009530stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9531 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9532 Access control for statistics
9533
9534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9535 no | no | yes | yes
9536
9537 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9538 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9539 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9540 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9541 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9542 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9543
9544 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9545 instance.
9546
9547 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9548 about ACL usage.
9549
9550
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009551stats realm <realm>
9552 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009554 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009555 Arguments :
9556 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9557 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9558 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9559
9560 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9561 using a backslash ('\').
9562
9563 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9564 only related to authentication.
9565
9566 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9567 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9568 unobvious parameters.
9569
9570 Example :
9571 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9572 backend public_www
9573 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9574 stats enable
9575 stats hide-version
9576 stats scope .
9577 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009578 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009579 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9580 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9581
9582 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9583 backend private_monitoring
9584 stats enable
9585 stats uri /admin?stats
9586 stats refresh 5s
9587
9588 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9589
9590
9591stats refresh <delay>
9592 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009594 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009595 Arguments :
9596 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9597 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9598 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9599 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9600 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9601 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9602
9603 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9604 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9605 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9606 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9607
9608 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9609 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9610 unobvious parameters.
9611
9612 Example :
9613 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9614 backend public_www
9615 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9616 stats enable
9617 stats hide-version
9618 stats scope .
9619 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009620 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009621 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9622 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9623
9624 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9625 backend private_monitoring
9626 stats enable
9627 stats uri /admin?stats
9628 stats refresh 5s
9629
9630 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9631
9632
9633stats scope { <name> | "." }
9634 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009636 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009637 Arguments :
9638 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9639 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9640 section in which the statement appears.
9641
9642 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9643 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9644 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9645 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9646 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9647 exists.
9648
9649 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9650 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9651 unobvious parameters.
9652
9653 Example :
9654 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9655 backend public_www
9656 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9657 stats enable
9658 stats hide-version
9659 stats scope .
9660 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009661 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009662 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9663 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9664
9665 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9666 backend private_monitoring
9667 stats enable
9668 stats uri /admin?stats
9669 stats refresh 5s
9670
9671 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9672
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009673
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009674stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009675 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009677 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009678
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009679 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009680 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9681
9682 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9683 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9684
9685 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9686 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009687 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009688
9689 Example :
9690 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9691 backend private_monitoring
9692 stats enable
9693 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9694 stats uri /admin?stats
9695 stats refresh 5s
9696
9697 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9698 global section.
9699
9700
9701stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009702 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9704 yes | yes | yes | yes
9705 Arguments : none
9706
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009707 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009708 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9709 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9710 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9711 - IP (socket, server)
9712 - cookie (backend, server)
9713
9714 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9715 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009716 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009717
9718 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9719
9720
9721stats show-node [ <name> ]
9722 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009724 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009725 Arguments:
9726 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9727 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9728
9729 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9730 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009731 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009732
9733 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9734 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9735 unobvious parameters.
9736
9737 Example:
9738 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9739 backend private_monitoring
9740 stats enable
9741 stats show-node Europe-1
9742 stats uri /admin?stats
9743 stats refresh 5s
9744
9745 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9746 section.
9747
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009748
9749stats uri <prefix>
9750 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009752 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009753 Arguments :
9754 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9755 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9756 query string.
9757
9758 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9759 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9760 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9761 possible to reach it in the application.
9762
9763 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009764 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009765 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9766 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9767 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9768 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9769
9770 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9771 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9772 an address or a port to statistics only.
9773
9774 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9775 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9776 unobvious parameters.
9777
9778 Example :
9779 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9780 backend public_www
9781 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9782 stats enable
9783 stats hide-version
9784 stats scope .
9785 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009786 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009787 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9788 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9789
9790 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9791 backend private_monitoring
9792 stats enable
9793 stats uri /admin?stats
9794 stats refresh 5s
9795
9796 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9797
9798
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009799stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9800 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009802 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009803
9804 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009805 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009806 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009807 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009808 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9809
9810 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9811 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9812 the "stick-table" statement.
9813
9814 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9815 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9816 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9817 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9818 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9819
9820 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9821 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9822 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9823 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9824 transformation rules.
9825
9826 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9827 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9828 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9829 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9830 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9831 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9832 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9833
9834 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9835 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9836 ACL based conditions.
9837
9838 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9839 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9840 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9841 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9842
9843 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9844 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9845 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9846 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9847
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009848 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9849 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009850 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009851
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009852 Example :
9853 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9854 # last 30 minutes
9855 backend pop
9856 mode tcp
9857 balance roundrobin
9858 stick store-request src
9859 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9860 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9861 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9862
9863 backend smtp
9864 mode tcp
9865 balance roundrobin
9866 stick match src table pop
9867 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9868 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9869
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009870 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009871 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009872
9873
9874stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9875 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9877 no | no | yes | yes
9878
9879 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9880 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9881 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9882 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9883
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009884 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9885 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009886 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009887
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009888 Examples :
9889 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009890 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009891
9892 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9893 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9894 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9895
9896
9897 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9898 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9899 backend http
9900 mode http
9901 balance roundrobin
9902 stick on src table https
9903 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9904 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9905 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9906
9907 backend https
9908 mode tcp
9909 balance roundrobin
9910 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9911 stick on src
9912 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9913 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9914
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009915 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009916
9917
9918stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9919 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9921 no | no | yes | yes
9922
9923 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009924 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009925 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009926 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009927 server is selected.
9928
9929 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9930 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9931 the "stick-table" statement.
9932
9933 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9934 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9935 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9936 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9937 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9938 address.
9939
9940 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9941 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9942 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9943 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9944 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9945 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9946 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9947 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9948 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9949 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9950
9951 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9952 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9953 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9954 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9955 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9956 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9957 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9958
9959 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9960 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9961 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9962 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9963
9964 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9965 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9966 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9967 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9968 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9969 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009970 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9971 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9972 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9973 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9974 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9975 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009976
9977 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9978 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9979 the request.
9980
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009981 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9982 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009983 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009984
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009985 Example :
9986 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9987 # last 30 minutes
9988 backend pop
9989 mode tcp
9990 balance roundrobin
9991 stick store-request src
9992 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9993 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9994 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9995
9996 backend smtp
9997 mode tcp
9998 balance roundrobin
9999 stick match src table pop
10000 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10001 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10002
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010003 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010004 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010005
10006
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010007stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010008 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10009 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010010 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010012 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010013
10014 Arguments :
10015 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10016 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10017 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10018 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10019
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010020 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10021 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10022 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10023 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10024
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010025 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10026 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10027 instance.
10028
10029 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10030 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10031 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10032 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10033 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10034 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010035 to 32 characters.
10036
10037 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10038 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10039 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010040 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010041 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10042 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010043
10044 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010045 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10046 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010047 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10048 increase.
10049
10050 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010051 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10052 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10053 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010054
10055 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10056 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10057 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10058 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010059 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010060 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10061 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10062 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10063 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10064 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10065 parameter (see below).
10066
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010067 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10068 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10069 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10070 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10071 soft restart.
10072
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010073 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10074 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010075
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010076 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10077 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10078 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10079 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010080 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010081 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010082 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10083 if not expiration delay is specified.
10084
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010085 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10086 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10087 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10088 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010089 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10090 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10091 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10092 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10093 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10094 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10095 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10096 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10097 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10098 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10099 types and their arguments.
10100
10101 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10102 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10103 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10104 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10105
10106 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10107 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10108 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010109 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010110
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010111 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10112 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10113 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010114 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010115 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010116 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010117
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010118 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10119 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10120 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10121 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10122
10123 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10124 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10125 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10126 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10127 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10128 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10129
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010130 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10131 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10132 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10133 they were received.
10134
10135 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10136 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10137 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10138 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10139 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10140
10141 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10142 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10143 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10144 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10145 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10146
10147 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10148 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10149 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10150
10151 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10152 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10153 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10154 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10155 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10156
10157 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10158 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10159 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10160 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10161 the client side.
10162
10163 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10164 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10165 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10166 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10167 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10168 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10169 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10170
10171 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10172 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10173 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10174 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10175 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10176 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010177 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010178
10179 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10180 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10181 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10182 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10183 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10184 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10185
10186 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010187 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010188 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10189 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10190
10191 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10192 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10193 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10194 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10195 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10196 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10197 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10198 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10199 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10200 recommended for better fairness.
10201
10202 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010203 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010204 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10205 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10206
10207 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10208 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10209 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10210 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10211 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10212 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10213 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10214 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10215 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10216 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010217
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010218 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10219 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010220 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10221 reference it.
10222
10223 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10224 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010225 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10226 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10227 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010228
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010229 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10230 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10231 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10232 something that can be ignored.
10233
10234 Example:
10235 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10236 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10237 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10238 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10239
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010240 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010241 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010242
10243
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010244stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010245 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10247 no | no | yes | yes
10248
10249 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010250 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010251 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010252 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010253 server is selected.
10254
10255 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10256 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10257 the "stick-table" statement.
10258
10259 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10260 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10261 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10262 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10263
10264 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10265 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10266 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10267 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10268 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10269 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010270 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010271 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10272 rules.
10273
10274 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10275 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10276 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10277 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10278 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10279 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10280 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10281
10282 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10283 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10284 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10285 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10286
10287 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10288 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10289 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10290 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10291 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10292 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010293 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10294 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10295 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10296 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10297 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10298 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10299 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10300 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10301 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010302
10303 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10304
10305 Example :
10306 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10307 backend https
10308 mode tcp
10309 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010310 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010311 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010312
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010313 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10314 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10315
10316 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10317 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10318 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10319
10320 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10321 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010322
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010323 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10324 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10325 # at offset 44.
10326
10327 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10328 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10329
10330 # Learn on response if server hello.
10331 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010332
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010333 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10334 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10335
10336 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10337 extraction.
10338
10339
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010340tcp-check comment <string>
10341 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10342 it fails.
10343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10344 yes | no | yes | yes
10345
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010346 Arguments :
10347 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10348 rule fails.
10349
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010350 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10351 user-friendly error reporting.
10352
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010353 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10354 "tcp-check expect".
10355
10356
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010357tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10358 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010359 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010360 Opens a new connection
10361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010362 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010363
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010364 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010365 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10366
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010367 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010368 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010369
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010370 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010371 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10372 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010373 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010374
10375 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010376
10377 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10378
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010379 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10380
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010381 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10382
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010383 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10384
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010385 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10386 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10387 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10388 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10389
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010390 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10391 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10392 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10393 haproxy -vv.
10394
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010395 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010396
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010397 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10398 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10399 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10400
10401 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10402 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10403 of the sequence.
10404
10405 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10406 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10407 do.
10408
10409 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10410 unset-var or comment rules.
10411
10412 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010413 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10414 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10415 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10416 option tcp-check
10417 tcp-check connect
10418 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10419 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10420 tcp-check send \r\n
10421 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10422 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10423 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10424 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10425 tcp-check send \r\n
10426 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10427 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10428
10429 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10430 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010431 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010432 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10433 tcp-check connect port 143
10434 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10435 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10436
10437 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10438
10439
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010440tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010441 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010442 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010443 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010444 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010445 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010446 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010447
10448 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010449 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10450
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010451 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10452 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10453 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10454 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10455 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10456 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10457 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10458 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10459 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10460 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10461
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010462 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010463 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10464 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010465 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10466 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10467 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10468
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010469 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10470 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10471 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010472 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10473 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10474 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10475 example 404 with disable-on-404
10476 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10477 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010478 By default "L7OK" is used.
10479
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010480 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10481 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010482 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10483 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10484 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10485 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10486 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10487 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010488
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010489 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010490 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010491 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10492 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10493 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10494 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010495 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10496
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010497 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10498 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10499 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10500 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10501
10502 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10503 informational message reported in logs if an error
10504 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10505 log-format string.
10506
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010507 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10508 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10509 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10510 followed by some converters.
10511
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010512 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10513 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10514 with the usual backslash ('\').
10515 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010516 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010517 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10518 used upper or lower case.
10519
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010520 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10521
10522 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10523 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10524 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10525 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10526 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10527 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10528 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10529 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10530
10531 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10532 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10533 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10534 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10535 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10536 expression.
10537
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010538 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10539 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10540 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10541 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10542 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10543 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10544
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010545 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10546 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10547 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10548 this exact hexadecimal string.
10549 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10550
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010551 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10552 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10553 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10554 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10555 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10556 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10557 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10558 size.
10559
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010560 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10561 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10562 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10563 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10564 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10565 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10566 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10567 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10568 in a binary string before matching the response's
10569 buffer.
10570
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010571 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10572 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10573 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10574 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10575 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10576 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10577 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10578 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10579 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10580 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10581 the null character.
10582
10583 Examples :
10584 # perform a POP check
10585 option tcp-check
10586 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10587
10588 # perform an IMAP check
10589 option tcp-check
10590 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10591
10592 # look for the redis master server
10593 option tcp-check
10594 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010595 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010596 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10597 tcp-check expect string role:master
10598 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10599 tcp-check expect string +OK
10600
10601
10602 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10603 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10604
10605
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010606tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10607tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10608 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10609 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010611 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010612
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010613 Arguments :
10614 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10615
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010616 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10617 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010618
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010619 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10620 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010621
10622 Examples :
10623 # look for the redis master server
10624 option tcp-check
10625 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10626 tcp-check expect string role:master
10627
10628 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10629 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10630
10631
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010632tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10633tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10634 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10635 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010636 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010637 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010638
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010639 Arguments :
10640 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010641
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010642 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10643 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010644
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010645 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10646 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10647 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010648
10649 Examples :
10650 # redis check in binary
10651 option tcp-check
10652 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10653 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10654
10655
10656 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10657 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10658
10659
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010660tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010661 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010663 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010664
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010665 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010666 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10667 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10668 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10669 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10670 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10671 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10672 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10673 and '-'.
10674
10675 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10676
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010677 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010678 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10679
10680
10681tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010682 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010684 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010685
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010686 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010687 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10688 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10689 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10690 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10691 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10692 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10693 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10694 and '-'.
10695
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010696 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010697 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10698
10699
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010700tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10701 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10703 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010704 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010705 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10706 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010707
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010708 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010709
10710 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10711 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010712 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10713 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10714 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10715 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10716 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10717 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010719 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10720 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10721 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10722 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010723
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010724 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010725 - accept :
10726 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10727 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10728 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010729
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010730 - reject :
10731 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10732 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10733 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10734 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10735 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10736 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10737 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10738 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10739 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10740 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10741 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010742 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010743
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010744 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10745 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10746 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10747 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10748 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10749 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10750 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10751 hosts.
10752
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010753 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10754 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10755 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10756 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10757 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10758 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10759 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10760 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10761
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010762 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10763 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10764 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10765 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10766 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10767 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10768 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10769 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10770 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010771 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10772 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010773
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010774 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010775 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010776 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10777 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10778 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010779 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010780 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10781 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10782 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10783 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10784 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10785 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10786 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10787 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010788
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010789 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010790 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010791 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010792 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010793 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10794 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10795 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010796
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010797 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10798 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10799 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10800 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010801
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010802 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10803 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10804 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10805 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10806 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010807 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10808 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10809 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10810 layer7 information is extracted.
10811
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010812 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10813 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10814 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10815 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10816 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010817
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010818 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10819 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10820 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10821 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10822
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010823 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10824 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10825 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10826 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10827
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010828 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10829 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10830 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10831 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10832 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010833
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010834 - set-src <expr> :
10835 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10836 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10837 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010838 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010840 Arguments:
10841 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10842 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010843
10844 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010845 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10846
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010847 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10848 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010849
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010850 - set-src-port <expr> :
10851 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10852 expression.
10853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010854 Arguments:
10855 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10856 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010857
10858 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010859 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10860
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010861 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10862 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10863 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010864
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010865 - set-dst <expr> :
10866 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10867 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10868 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10869 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10870 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10871
10872 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10873 followed by some converters.
10874
10875 Example:
10876
10877 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10878 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10879
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010880 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10881 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10882
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010883 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10884 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10885 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10886 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10887
10888
10889 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10890 followed by some converters.
10891
10892 Example:
10893
10894 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10895
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010896 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10897 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10898 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10899
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010900 - "silent-drop" :
10901 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010902 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010903 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10904 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10905 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10906 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10907 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010908 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10909 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010910 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10911 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010912 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010913 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10914 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10915 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10916 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10917
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010918 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10919 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10920 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010921
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010922 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10923 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10924 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010925
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010926 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010927 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010928 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010929
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010930 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10931 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10932 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010933
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010934 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010935 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10936 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010937
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010938 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10939
10940 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10941
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010942 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10943
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010944 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010945
10946
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010947tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10948 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010950 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010951 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010952 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10953 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010955 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010956
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010957 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010958 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10959 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10960 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10961 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010963 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10964 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10965 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10966 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010967 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10968 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10969 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10970 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10971 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10972 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010973 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010974 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010975
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010976 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10977 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10978 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10979 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010980
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010981 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010982 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010983 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010984 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10985 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010986 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010987 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010988 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010989 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010990 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010991 - set-dst <expr>
10992 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010993 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010994 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010995 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010996 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010997 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010999 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11000 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011001 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11002 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011003
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011004 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11005 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11006 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11007 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11008 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11009 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011011 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011012 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11013 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011015 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011016 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11017 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11018 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11019 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011020 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11021 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11022 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011023
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011024 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011025 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11026 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11027 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011028
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011029 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11030 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11031
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011032 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011033 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11034 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011035
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011036 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11037 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011038 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011039 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11040 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011041 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011042 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011043 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011044 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11045 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011046 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011047 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11048 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011049
11050 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11051 followed by some converters.
11052
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011053 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11054 <var-name>.
11055
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011056 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11057 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11058 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11059 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11060 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11061
11062 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11063 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11064 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11065 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11066 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11067 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11068 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11069 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11070 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11071 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11072 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11073
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011074 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11075 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11076 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11077 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11078 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11079
11080 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11081
11082 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11083
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011084 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11085 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11086 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11087 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11088 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11089 evaluated.
11090
11091 Example:
11092 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11093
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011094 Example:
11095
11096 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011097 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011098
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011099 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011100 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11101 # and reject everything else.
11102 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11103 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011104 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011105 tcp-request content reject
11106
11107 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011108 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11109 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11110 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011111 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011112
11113 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11114 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11115 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011116 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011117 tcp-request content reject
11118
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011119 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011120 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011121 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011122 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011123 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11124 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011125
11126 Example:
11127 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11128 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011129 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011130
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011131 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011132 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011133
11134 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011135 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011136 # protecting all our sites
11137 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011138 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11139 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011140 ...
11141 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11142
11143 backend http_dynamic
11144 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011145 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011146 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011147 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011148 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011149 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011150 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011152 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011153
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011154 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11155 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011156
11157
11158tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11159 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011161 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011162 Arguments :
11163 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11164 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11165 as explained at the top of this document.
11166
11167 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11168 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11169 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11170 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11171 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11172
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011173 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11174 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11175 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11176 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11177
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011178 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11179 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011180 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011181 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011182 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11183 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11184 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11185 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011186
11187 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11188 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11189 it pass through unaffected.
11190
11191 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11192 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11193 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011194 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011195 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11196 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011197 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11198 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11199 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011200
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011201 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011202 "timeout client".
11203
11204
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011205tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11206 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11208 no | no | yes | yes
11209 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011210 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11211 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011212
11213 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11214
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011215 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011216 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11217 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011218 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11219 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011220
11221 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11222
11223 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11224 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11225 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11226 inserted.
11227
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011228 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011229 - accept :
11230 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11231 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11232 the rules evaluation.
11233
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011234 - close :
11235 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11236 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11237 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11238 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11239 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11240 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011241 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011242 protocols.
11243
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011244 - reject :
11245 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11246 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011247 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011248
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011249 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11250 Sets a variable.
11251
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011252 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11253 Unsets a variable.
11254
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011255 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11256 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11257 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11258 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11259
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011260 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11261 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11262 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11263 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11264
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011265 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11266 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11267 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11268 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11269 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011270
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011271 - "silent-drop" :
11272 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011273 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011274 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11275 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11276 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11277 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11278 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011279 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11280 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011281 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11282 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011283 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011284 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11285 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11286 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11287 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11288
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011289 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11290 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11291
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011292 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11293 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11294 for changing the default action to a reject.
11295
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011296 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11297 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11298 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11299 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011300 period.
11301
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011302 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11303 declared inline.
11304
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011305 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11306 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011307 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011308 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11309 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011310 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011311 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011312 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011313 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11314 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011315 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011316 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11317 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011318
11319 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11320 followed by some converters.
11321
11322 Example:
11323
11324 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11325
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011326 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11327 <var-name>.
11328
11329 Example:
11330
11331 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11332
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011333 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11334 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11335 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11336 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11337 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11338
11339 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11340
11341 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11342
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011343 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11344
11345 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11346
11347
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011348tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11349 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11351 no | yes | yes | no
11352 Arguments :
11353 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11354 below.
11355
11356 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11357
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011358 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011359 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11360 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11361 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11362 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11363 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11364 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11365 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011366 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011367 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11368 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11369 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11370 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11371 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11372 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11373 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11374 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11375 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11376 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11377 instead.
11378
11379 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11380 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11381 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11382 rules which may be inserted.
11383
11384 Several types of actions are supported :
11385 - accept : the request is accepted
11386 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11387 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11388 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011389 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011390 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011391 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011392 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011393 - silent-drop
11394
11395 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11396 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11397 sections for a complete description.
11398
11399 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11400 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11401 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11402
11403 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11404 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11405 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11406 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11407 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11408
11409 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11410 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11411
11412 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11413 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11414 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11415
11416 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11417 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11418 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11419
11420 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11421 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11422 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11423
11424 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11425 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11426 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11427
11428 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11429
11430 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11431
11432
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011433tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11434 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11436 no | no | yes | yes
11437 Arguments :
11438 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11439 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11440 as explained at the top of this document.
11441
11442 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11443
11444
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011445timeout check <timeout>
11446 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11447 established.
11448
11449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11450 yes | no | yes | yes
11451 Arguments:
11452 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11453 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11454 as explained at the top of this document.
11455
11456 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11457 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011458 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011459 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011460 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11461 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11462 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011463
11464 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11465 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11466
11467 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11468 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011469 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011470
11471 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11472 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11473 forget about it.
11474
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011475 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11476 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011477
11478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011479timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011480 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11482 yes | yes | yes | no
11483 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011484 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011485 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11486 as explained at the top of this document.
11487
11488 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11489 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11490 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011491 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11492 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11493 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11494 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011495 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11496 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11497 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011498 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011499 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011500 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11501 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011502 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11503 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011504
11505 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11506 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11507 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11508 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011509 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011510 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11511
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011512 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011513
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011514 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011515
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011516
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011517timeout client-fin <timeout>
11518 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11520 yes | yes | yes | no
11521 Arguments :
11522 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11523 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11524 as explained at the top of this document.
11525
11526 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11527 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11528 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11529 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11530 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11531 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11532 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011533 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11534 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11535 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011536
11537 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11538 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11539 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11540
11541 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11542
11543
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011544timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011545 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11547 yes | no | yes | yes
11548 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011549 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011550 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11551 as explained at the top of this document.
11552
11553 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011554 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011555 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011556 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011557 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11558 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011559
11560 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11561 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11562 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11563 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011564 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011565 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11566
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011567 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011568
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011569
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011570timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11571 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11573 yes | yes | yes | yes
11574 Arguments :
11575 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11576 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11577 as explained at the top of this document.
11578
11579 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11580 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11581 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11582 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11583 once the request has started to present itself.
11584
11585 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11586 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11587 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11588 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11589 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11590
11591 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11592 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11593 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11594 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11595
11596 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11597 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011598 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011599 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11600 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011601 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011602
11603 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11604 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11605 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11606 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11607
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011608 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11609 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011610 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11611
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011612 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11613
11614
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011615timeout http-request <timeout>
11616 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011618 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011620 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011621 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11622 as explained at the top of this document.
11623
11624 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11625 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11626 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11627 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11628 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11629 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11630 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011631 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11632 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11633 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11634 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011635 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011636 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11637 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011638
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011639 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11640 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11641 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11642 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11643 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011644 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011645
11646 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11647 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011648 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011649 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11650 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11651
11652 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011653 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11654 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11655 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011656
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011657 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011658 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011659
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011660
11661timeout queue <timeout>
11662 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11664 yes | no | yes | yes
11665 Arguments :
11666 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11667 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11668 as explained at the top of this document.
11669
11670 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11671 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11672 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11673 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11674 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11675
11676 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11677 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11678 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11679 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11680
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011681 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011682
11683
11684timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011685 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11687 yes | no | yes | yes
11688 Arguments :
11689 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11690 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11691 as explained at the top of this document.
11692
11693 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11694 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11695 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11696 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11697 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11698 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11699 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11700
11701 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11702 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11703 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11704 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11705 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011706 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011707 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011708 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11709 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011710 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11711 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011712
11713 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11714 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11715 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11716 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011717 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011718 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11719
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011720 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011721
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011722
11723timeout server-fin <timeout>
11724 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11726 yes | no | yes | yes
11727 Arguments :
11728 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11729 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11730 as explained at the top of this document.
11731
11732 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11733 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11734 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11735 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11736 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11737 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11738 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11739 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11740 situations, it should not be needed.
11741
11742 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11743 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11744 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11745
11746 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11747
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011748
11749timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011750 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11752 yes | yes | yes | yes
11753 Arguments :
11754 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11756 as explained at the top of this document.
11757
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011758 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11759 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11760 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011761
11762 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11763 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11764 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11765 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011766 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011767
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011768 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011769
11770
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011771timeout tunnel <timeout>
11772 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11774 yes | no | yes | yes
11775 Arguments :
11776 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11778 as explained at the top of this document.
11779
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011780 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011781 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11782 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11783 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011784 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11785 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011786 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11787 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11788 specified.
11789
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011790 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11791 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11792 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11793 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11794 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11795 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11796 state.
11797
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011798 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11799 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11800 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11801 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011802 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011803
11804 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11805 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11806 forget about it.
11807
11808 Example :
11809 defaults http
11810 option http-server-close
11811 timeout connect 5s
11812 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011813 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011814 timeout server 30s
11815 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11816
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011817 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011818
11819
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011820transparent (deprecated)
11821 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011823 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011824 Arguments : none
11825
11826 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11827 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11828 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11829 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11830 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11831 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11832 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11833 appropriate server.
11834
11835 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11836
11837 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11838 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11839
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011840 See also: "option transparent"
11841
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011842unique-id-format <string>
11843 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11845 yes | yes | yes | no
11846 Arguments :
11847 <string> is a log-format string.
11848
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011849 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11850 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11851 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11852 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011853
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011854 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11855 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11856 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11857 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11858 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11859 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11860 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11861 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011862
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011863 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11864 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011865
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011866 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011867
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011868 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011869
11870 will generate:
11871
11872 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11873
11874 See also: "unique-id-header"
11875
11876unique-id-header <name>
11877 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11879 yes | yes | yes | no
11880 Arguments :
11881 <name> is the name of the header.
11882
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011883 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11884 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011885
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011886 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011887
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011888 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011889 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11890
11891 will generate:
11892
11893 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11894
11895 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011896
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011897use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011898 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11900 no | yes | yes | no
11901 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011902 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11903 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011904
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011905 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11906 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011907
11908 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11909 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11910 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011911 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011912 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011913 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11914 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011915
11916 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11917 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11918 assign the backend.
11919
11920 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11921 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11922 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11923 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11924 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11925 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11926
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011927 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011928 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011929 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11930 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11931 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11932
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011933 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11934 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11935 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11936 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11937 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11938 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11939 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11940 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11941 cannot be forced from the request.
11942
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011943 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011944 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11945 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11946
11947 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11948 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011949
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011950use-fcgi-app <name>
11951 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11953 no | no | yes | yes
11954 Arguments :
11955 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11956
11957 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011958
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011959use-server <server> if <condition>
11960use-server <server> unless <condition>
11961 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11963 no | no | yes | yes
11964 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011965 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11966 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011967
11968 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11969
11970 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11971 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11972 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11973
11974 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11975 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11976 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11977 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11978 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11979 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11980 matches will assign the server.
11981
11982 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11983 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11984 with the next rules until one matches.
11985
11986 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11987 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11988 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11989 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11990
11991 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11992 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11993 stripped.
11994
11995 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11996 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11997 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11998 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11999
12000 Example :
12001 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12002 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12003 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12004 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
12005 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
12006 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012007 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012008 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12009 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12010
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012011 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12012 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12013 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12014 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
12015 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
12016 and we fall back to load balancing.
12017
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012018 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012019
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012020
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120215. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012022--------------------------
12023
12024The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12025depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12026settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12027written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12028described in this section.
12029
12030
120315.1. Bind options
12032-----------------
12033
12034The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12035as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12036no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12037parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12038while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12039provided immediately after the setting name.
12040
12041The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12042
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012043accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12044 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12045 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12046 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12047 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12048 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12049 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12050 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12051 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12052 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012053 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12054 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12055 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012056
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012057accept-proxy
12058 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012059 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12060 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012061 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12062 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12063 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12064 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012065 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012066 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12067 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012068 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12069 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012070
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012071allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012072 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012073 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012074 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012075 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12076 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012077
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012078alpn <protocols>
12079 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12080 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12081 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012082 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012083 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012084 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12085 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12086 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12087 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12088 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12089 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12090 preference, like below :
12091
12092 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012093
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012094backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012095 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012096 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12097
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012098curves <curves>
12099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12100 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12101 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12102 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12103 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12104 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12105
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012106ecdhe <named curve>
12107 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012108 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12109 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012110
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012111ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12113 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12114 client's certificate.
12115
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012116ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12117 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12118 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12119 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12120 error is ignored.
12121
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012122ca-sign-file <cafile>
12123 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12124 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12125 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12126 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12127 'generate-certificates' for details.
12128
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012129ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012130 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12131 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12132 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12133 'generate-certificates' for details.
12134
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012135ca-verify-file <cafile>
12136 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12137 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12138 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12139 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12140 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12141
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012142ciphers <ciphers>
12143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12144 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012145 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012146 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012147 information and recommendations see e.g.
12148 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12149 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12150 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12151
12152ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12154 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12155 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12156 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012157 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12158 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012159
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012160crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12162 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12163 to verify client's certificate.
12164
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012165crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12167 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12168 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12169 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12170 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012171 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12172 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012173
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012174 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12175 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12176
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012177 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12178 are loaded.
12179
12180 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012181 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12182 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12183 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12184 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12185 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12186 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12187 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012188 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012189
12190 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12191 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12192 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12193 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012194 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12195 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012196
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012197 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012198
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012199 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012200 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012201 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12202 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012203 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12204 clients).
12205
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012206 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12207 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12208 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12209 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12210 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12211 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12212 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12213 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12214 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12215 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12216 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12217 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12218 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12219
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012220 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12221 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12222 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12223 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12224 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12225
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012226 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12227 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12228 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12229 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012230
12231 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12232 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12233 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12234 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12235 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12236 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12237 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12238 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12239 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12240
12241 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12242
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012243 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012244 a cert bundle.
12245
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012246 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012247 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12248 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12249 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12250 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12251 provide multi-cert support.
12252
12253 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12254
12255 Filename | CN | SAN
12256 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12257 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012258 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012259 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12260 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12261
12262 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12263 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12264 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12265 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012266 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12267 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12268 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012269
12270 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12271 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12272
12273 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12274 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12275 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12276
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012277crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012279 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012280 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012281 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012282
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012283crt-list <file>
12284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012285 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12286 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012287
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012288 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12289
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012290 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12291 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
12292 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
12293 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012294
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012295 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12296 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12297 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12298 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12299 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12300 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12301 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12302 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012303
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012304 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012305 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012306 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12307 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12308 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012309
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012310 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12311
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012312 crt-list file example:
12313 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012314 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012315 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012316 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012317 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012318
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012319defer-accept
12320 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12321 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12322 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012323 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012324 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12325 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12326 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12327 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12328 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12329 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12330 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12331
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012332expose-fd listeners
12333 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12334 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012335 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12336 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012337 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012338
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012339force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012340 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012341 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012342 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012343 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012344
12345force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012346 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012347 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012348 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012349
12350force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012351 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012352 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012353 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012354
12355force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012356 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012357 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012358 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012359
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012360force-tlsv13
12361 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12362 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012363 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012364
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012365generate-certificates
12366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12367 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12368 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12369 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12370 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12371 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12372 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12373 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12374 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12375 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12376 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12377
12378 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12379 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012380 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012381 certificate is used many times.
12382
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012383gid <gid>
12384 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12385 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12386 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12387 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12388 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12389
12390group <group>
12391 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12392 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12393 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12394 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12395 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12396
12397id <id>
12398 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12399 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12400 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12401 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12402
12403interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012404 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12405 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12406 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12407 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12408 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12409 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012410 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12411 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12412 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12413 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12414 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12415 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012416
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012417level <level>
12418 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12419 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12420 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012421 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012422 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12423 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12424 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012425 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012426 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012427 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012428 all counters).
12429
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012430severity-output <format>
12431 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12432 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12433 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12434 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12435 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12436 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12437 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12438 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12439 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12440 rfc5424 convention.
12441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012442maxconn <maxconn>
12443 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12444 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12445 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12446 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12447 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12448 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12449 eat all memory.
12450
12451mode <mode>
12452 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12453 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12454 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12455 UNIX sockets.
12456
12457mss <maxseg>
12458 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12459 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12460 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12461 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12462 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12463 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12464 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12465 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12466 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12467 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12468 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12469
12470name <name>
12471 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12472 page.
12473
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012474namespace <name>
12475 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12476 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12477 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12478 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12479
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012480nice <nice>
12481 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12482 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12483 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12484 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12485 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12486 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12487 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12488 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12489 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12490 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12491 one for an RDP socket.
12492
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012493no-ca-names
12494 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12495 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012496 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012497
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012498no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012500 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012501 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012502 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012503 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12504 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012505
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012506no-tls-tickets
12507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12508 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12509 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012510 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12511 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012512 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12513 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12514 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012515
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012516no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012518 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012519 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012520 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012521 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12522 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012523
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012524no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012525 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012526 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012527 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012528 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012529 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12530 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012531
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012532no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012534 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012535 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012536 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012537 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12538 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012539
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012540no-tlsv13
12541 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12542 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12543 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12544 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012545 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12546 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012547
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012548npn <protocols>
12549 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12550 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12551 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012552 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012553 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012554 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12555 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12556 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12557 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12558 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012559
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012560prefer-client-ciphers
12561 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12562 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12563 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012564 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12565 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12566 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012567
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012568process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012569 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012570 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012571 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012572 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12573 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12574 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12575 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012576 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012577 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12578 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12579 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12580 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12581 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012582
12583 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12584
12585 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12586 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12587 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12588 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12589 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12590 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12591 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12592 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012593
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012594proto <name>
12595 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12596 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12597 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12598 in haproxy -vv.
12599 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12600 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012601 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012602 h2" on the bind line.
12603
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012604ssl
12605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012606 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012607 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12608 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012609 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12610 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012611
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012612ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12613 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012614 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12615 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12616 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012617 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12618
12619ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012620 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12621 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12622 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12623 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012624
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012625strict-sni
12626 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12627 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12628 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12629 See the "crt" option for more information.
12630
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012631tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012632 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012633 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12634 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012635 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012636 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12637 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12638 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12639 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12640 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12641 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12642 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12643
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012644tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012645 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012646 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12647 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12648 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12649 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12650 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12651 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12652 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012653 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12654 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12655 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012656
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012657tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12658 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012659 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12660 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12661 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12662 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12663 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12664 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12665 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12666 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12667 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12668 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012669 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12670 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012672transparent
12673 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12674 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12675 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12676 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12677 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12678 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12679 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12680 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12681 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12682 so check for support with your vendor.
12683
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012684v4v6
12685 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12686 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12687 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12688 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012689 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012690
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012691v6only
12692 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12693 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12694 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012695 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12696 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012697
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012698uid <uid>
12699 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12700 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12701 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12702 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12703 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12704
12705user <user>
12706 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12707 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12708 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12709 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12710 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12711
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012712verify [none|optional|required]
12713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12714 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12715 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12716 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12717 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012718 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12719 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12720 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12721 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012722
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200127235.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012724------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012726The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12727which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12728arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12729settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12730after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12731Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12732address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012734 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012735 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012736
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012737Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12738keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012740The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012741
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012742addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012743 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012744 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12745 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12746 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12747 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12748 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012749
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012750agent-check
12751 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012752 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012753 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12754 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12755 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012756
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012757 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012758 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012759 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12760 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12761 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012762
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012763 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12764 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12765 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12766 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12767 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012768
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012769 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012770 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012771
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012772 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12773 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12774 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012775
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012776 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12777 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12778 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012779
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012780 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12781 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12782 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12783 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12784 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012785 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012786 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012787
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012788 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12789 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012790
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012791 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12792 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12793 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12794 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12795 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12796 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12797 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12798 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12799 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012800
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012801 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12802 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012803 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12804 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12805 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012806 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012807
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012808 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012809 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012810
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012811agent-send <string>
12812 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12813 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12814 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12815 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12816 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12817
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012818agent-inter <delay>
12819 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12820 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12821
12822 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12823 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12824 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12825 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12826 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12827 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12828 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12829 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12830 of backends use the same servers.
12831
12832 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12833
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012834agent-addr <addr>
12835 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12836
12837 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12838 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12839 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12840 hostname, it will be resolved.
12841
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012842agent-port <port>
12843 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12844
12845 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12846
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012847allow-0rtt
12848 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012849 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12850 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012851
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012852alpn <protocols>
12853 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12854 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12855 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012856 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012857 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12858 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12859 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12860 now obsolete NPN extension.
12861 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12862 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12863
12864 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012866backup
12867 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12868 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12869 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12870 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012871 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12872 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012873
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012874ca-file <cafile>
12875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12876 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12877 server's certificate.
12878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012879check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012880 This option enables health checks on a server:
12881 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12882 considered available.
12883 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12884 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12885 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12886 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12887 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12888 set.
12889 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12890 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12891 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12892 exchanges succeed.
12893
12894 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12895 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12896 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12897 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12898 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012899 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012900 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12901
12902 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12903 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12904
12905 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12906 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12907
12908 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12909 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12910 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12911 available.
12912
12913 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12914 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12915 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12916
12917 Example:
12918 # simple tcp check
12919 backend foo
12920 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12921 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12922 backend foo
12923 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12924 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12925 backend foo
12926 option tcp-check
12927 tcp-check connect
12928 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012929
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012930check-send-proxy
12931 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12932 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12933 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12934 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12935 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12936 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12937 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12938
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012939check-alpn <protocols>
12940 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12941 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12942 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12943
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012944check-proto <name>
12945 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12946 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12947 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12948 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12949 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12950 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12951 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12952
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012953check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012954 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012955 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12956 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012957
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012958check-ssl
12959 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12960 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12961 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12962 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012963 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012964 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12965 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012966 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012967 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12968 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012969
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012970check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012971 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012972 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12973 for normal traffic.
12974
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012975ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012976 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12977 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12978 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012979 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12980 information and recommendations see e.g.
12981 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12982 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12983 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012984
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012985ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12986 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12987 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12988 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12989 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012990 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12991 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12992 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012994cookie <value>
12995 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12996 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12997 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12998 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12999 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13000 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13001 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13002
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013003crl-file <crlfile>
13004 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13005 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13006 to verify server's certificate.
13007
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013008crt <cert>
13009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13010 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13011 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13012 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13013 certificate request.
13014
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013015disabled
13016 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13017 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13018 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13019 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13020 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013021 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013022
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013023enabled
13024 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13025 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13026 default value.
13027 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13028 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013030error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013031 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13032 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13033 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013035 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013037fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013038 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13039 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13040 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13041
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013042force-sslv3
13043 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13044 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013045 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013046 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013047
13048force-tlsv10
13049 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013050 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013051 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013052
13053force-tlsv11
13054 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013055 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013056 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013057
13058force-tlsv12
13059 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013060 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013061 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013062
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013063force-tlsv13
13064 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13065 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013066 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013068id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013069 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13070 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13071 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013072
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013073init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13074 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13075 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013076 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013077 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13078 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13079 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13080 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13081 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13082 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13083 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13084 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13085 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013086 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013087 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13088 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13089 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13090 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13091 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13092 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013093 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013094
13095 Example:
13096 defaults
13097 # never fail on address resolution
13098 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013100inter <delay>
13101fastinter <delay>
13102downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013103 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13104 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13105 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13106 between checks depending on the server state :
13107
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013108 Server state | Interval used
13109 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13110 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13111 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13112 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13113 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13114 or yet unchecked. |
13115 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13116 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13117 | "inter" otherwise.
13118 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013120 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13121 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13122 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13123 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013124 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13125 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13126 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13127 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13128 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013129
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013130log-proto <logproto>
13131 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13132 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13133 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13134 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013136maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013137 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13138 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013139 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13140 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013141 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13142 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13143 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13144 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13145
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013146 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13147 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13148 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13149 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13150 than 50 concurrent requests.
13151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013152maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013153 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13154 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13155 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13156 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13157 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13158 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13159 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13160
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013161max-reuse <count>
13162 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13163 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13164 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13165 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13166 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13167 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13168 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13169 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13170
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013171minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013172 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13173 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13174 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13175 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13176 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13177 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013178 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013179 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013180
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013181namespace <name>
13182 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13183 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13184 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13185 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13186
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013187no-agent-check
13188 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13189 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13190 default value.
13191 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13192 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13193
13194no-backup
13195 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13196 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13197 default value.
13198 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13199 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13200
13201no-check
13202 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13203 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13204 default value.
13205 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13206 "default-server" "check" setting.
13207
13208no-check-ssl
13209 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13210 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13211 default value.
13212 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13213 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13214
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013215no-send-proxy
13216 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13217 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13218 default value.
13219 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13220 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13221
13222no-send-proxy-v2
13223 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13224 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13225 default value.
13226 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13227 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13228
13229no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13230 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13231 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13232 default value.
13233 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13234 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13235
13236no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13237 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13238 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13239 default value.
13240 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13241 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13242
13243no-ssl
13244 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13245 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13246 default value.
13247 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13248 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13249
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013250no-ssl-reuse
13251 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13252 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13253 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13254 and for paranoid users.
13255
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013256no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013257 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13258 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013259 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013260
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013261 Supported in default-server: No
13262
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013263no-tls-tickets
13264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13265 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13266 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013267 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13268 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013269 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13270 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13271 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013272 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013273
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013274no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013275 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013276 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13277 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013278 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13279 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013280 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013281
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013282 Supported in default-server: No
13283
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013284no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013285 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013286 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13287 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013288 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13289 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013290 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013291
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013292 Supported in default-server: No
13293
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013294no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013295 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013296 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13297 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013298 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13299 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013300 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013301
13302 Supported in default-server: No
13303
13304no-tlsv13
13305 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13306 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13307 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13308 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13309 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013310 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013311
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013312 Supported in default-server: No
13313
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013314no-verifyhost
13315 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13316 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13317 default value.
13318 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13319 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013320
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013321no-tfo
13322 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13323 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13324 default value.
13325 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13326 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13327
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013328non-stick
13329 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13330 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13331 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13332
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013333npn <protocols>
13334 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13335 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13336 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013337 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013338 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13339 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13340 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013342observe <mode>
13343 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13344 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13345 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13346 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13347 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13348 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013349 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013350
13351 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013353on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013354 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13355 Currently, four modes are available:
13356 - fastinter: force fastinter
13357 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13358 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13359 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13360 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13361
13362 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13363
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013364on-marked-down <action>
13365 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13366 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013367 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13368 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13369 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13370 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13371 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13372 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13373 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13374 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013375
13376 Actions are disabled by default
13377
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013378on-marked-up <action>
13379 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13380 Currently one action is available:
13381 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13382 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13383 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13384 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013385 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13386 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013387 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13388 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13389
13390 Actions are disabled by default
13391
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013392pool-max-conn <max>
13393 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13394 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13395 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13396 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13397 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13398 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13399
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013400pool-purge-delay <delay>
13401 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013402 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013403 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013404
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013405port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013406 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13407 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13408 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13409 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13410 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13411 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13412
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013413proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013414 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13415 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13416 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13417 reported in haproxy -vv.
13418 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13419 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013421redir <prefix>
13422 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13423 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13424 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13425 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13426 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13427 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13428 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13429 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013430 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013431 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013432 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13433 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13434 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13435 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13436
13437 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013439rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013440 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13441 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13442 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13443
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013444resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13445 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13446 server.
13447
13448 Available options:
13449
13450 * allow-dup-ip
13451 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13452 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13453 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13454 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13455 For such case, simply enable this option.
13456 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13457
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013458 * ignore-weight
13459 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13460 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13461 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13462
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013463 * prevent-dup-ip
13464 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13465 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13466 same fqdn.
13467 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13468
13469 Example:
13470 backend b_myapp
13471 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13472 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13473 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13474
13475 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13476 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13477 it
13478 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13479 different address
13480
13481 Default value: not set
13482
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013483resolve-prefer <family>
13484 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13485 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13486 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13487 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13488
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013489 Default value: ipv6
13490
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013491 Example:
13492
13493 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013494
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013495resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013496 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013497 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013498 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013499 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13500 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013501 configured network, another address is selected.
13502
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013503 Example:
13504
13505 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013506
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013507resolvers <id>
13508 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13509 hostname.
13510
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013511 Example:
13512
13513 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013514
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013515 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013516
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013517send-proxy
13518 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13519 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13520 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13521 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013522 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13523 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13524 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13525 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13526 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13527 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13528 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13529 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13530 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13531 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013532 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13533 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013534
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013535send-proxy-v2
13536 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13537 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13538 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13539 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013540 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13541 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13542 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13543 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013544
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013545proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013546 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13547 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13548
13549 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13550 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13551 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13552 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13553 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13554 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13555 connection is supported).
13556 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13557 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13558 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13559 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13560 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13561 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13562 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013563
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013564send-proxy-v2-ssl
13565 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13566 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13567 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13568 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13569 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13570 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13571 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013572 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13573 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013574
13575send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13576 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13577 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13578 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13579 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13580 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13581 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13582 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13583 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013584 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13585 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013587slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013588 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13589 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13590 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13591 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13592 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13593 parameters :
13594
13595 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13596 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13597
13598 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13599 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13600 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13601 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13602
13603 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13604 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13605 seen as failed.
13606
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013607sni <expression>
13608 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13609 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13610 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13611 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013612 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13613 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013614 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013615 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13616 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013617
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013618source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013619source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013620source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013621 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13622 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13623 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13624 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13625
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013626 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13627 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13628 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13629 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13630 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13631 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13632 server.
13633
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013634 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13635 specifying the source address without port(s).
13636
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013637ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013638 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13639 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13640 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13641 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13642 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13643 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013644 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13645 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013646
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013647ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13648 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13649 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13650 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13651
13652ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13653 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13654 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13655 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13656
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013657ssl-reuse
13658 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13659 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13660 default value.
13661 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13662 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13663
13664stick
13665 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13666 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13667 default value.
13668 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13669 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013670
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013671socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013672 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013673 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13674 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13675
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013676tcp-ut <delay>
13677 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13678 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13679 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013680 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013681 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13682 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13683 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13684 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13685 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13686 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13687 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13688 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13689 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13690
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013691tfo
13692 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13693 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13694 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13695 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13696 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013697 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013699track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013700 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13701 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13702 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13703 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013704 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13705
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013706tls-tickets
13707 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13708 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13709 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013710 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13711 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13712 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013713 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013714 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013715
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013716verify [none|required]
13717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013718 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013719 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13720 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013721 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013722 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13723 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13724 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13725 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13726 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13727 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13728 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13729 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013730
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013731verifyhost <hostname>
13732 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013733 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13734 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13735 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13736 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13737 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13738 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13739 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13740 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013742weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013743 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13744 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13745 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013746 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13747 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13748 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13749 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13750 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13751 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013752
13753
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137545.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13755-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013756
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013757HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13758using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13759configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013760This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13761can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13762workload.
13763This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13764resolution at run time.
13765Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13766carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13767
13768
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137695.3.1. Global overview
13770----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013771
13772As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13773different steps of the process life:
13774
13775 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13776 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13777 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13778
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013779 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13780 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013781
13782A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13783 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13784 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13785 resolution to know this new IP.
13786
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013787When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013788HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013789SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13790from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13791will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13792will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013793
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013794A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013795 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013796 first valid response.
13797
13798 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13799 servers return an error.
13800
13801
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138025.3.2. The resolvers section
13803----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013804
13805This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013806HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13807contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013808
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013809When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13810uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13811is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13812answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13813
13814When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013815used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013816
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013817 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13818 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13819 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013820
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013821 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13822 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013823
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013824 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13825 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13826 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013827
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013828For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13829following scenarios are possible:
13830
13831 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13832 ignored
13833
13834 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13835 applied
13836
13837 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13838 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13839
13840 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13841 retries the query with a new type
13842
13843 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13844 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013845
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013846As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13847a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013848<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013849
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013850
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013851resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013852 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013853
13854A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13855
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013856accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013857 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013858 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013859 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13860 by RFC 6891)
13861
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013862 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13863
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013864nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13865 DNS server description:
13866 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13867 <ip> : IP address of the server
13868 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13869
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013870parse-resolv-conf
13871 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13872 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13873 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13874
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013875hold <status> <period>
13876 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13877 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013878 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013879 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013880 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13881 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13882 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13883
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013884 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013885
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013886resolve_retries <nb>
13887 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13888 giving up.
13889 Default value: 3
13890
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013891 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13892 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13893 type.
13894
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013895timeout <event> <time>
13896 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13897 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13898 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013899 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13900 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013901 Default value: 1s
13902 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013903 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013904 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013905 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13906 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13907
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013908 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013909
13910 resolvers mydns
13911 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13912 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013913 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013914 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013915 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013916 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013917 hold other 30s
13918 hold refused 30s
13919 hold nx 30s
13920 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013921 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013922 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013923
13924
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200139256. Cache
13926---------
13927
13928HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13929(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13930RAM.
13931
13932The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13933this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13934
13935If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13936independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13937when we try to allocate a new one.
13938
13939The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13940
13941It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13942"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13943for more details.
13944
13945When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13946replaced by "<CACHE>".
13947
13948
139496.1. Limitation
13950----------------
13951
13952The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13953
13954- If the response is not a 200
13955- If the response contains a Vary header
13956- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13957- If the response is not cacheable
13958
13959- If the request is not a GET
13960- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13961- If the request contains an Authorization header
13962
13963
139646.2. Setup
13965-----------
13966
13967To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13968the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13969
13970
139716.2.1. Cache section
13972---------------------
13973
13974cache <name>
13975 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13976 size of cache is mandatory.
13977
13978total-max-size <megabytes>
13979 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13980 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13981
13982max-object-size <bytes>
13983 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13984 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13985 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13986
13987max-age <seconds>
13988 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13989 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13990 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13991 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13992 default.
13993
13994
139956.2.2. Proxy section
13996---------------------
13997
13998http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13999 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14000 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14001 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14002 after this one.
14003
14004http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14005 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14006 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14007 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14008 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14009
14010
14011Example:
14012
14013 backend bck1
14014 mode http
14015
14016 http-request cache-use foobar
14017 http-response cache-store foobar
14018 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14019
14020 cache foobar
14021 total-max-size 4
14022 max-age 240
14023
14024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140257. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14026----------------------------------
14027
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014028HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014029client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14030The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14031these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14032but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14033data called patterns.
14034
14035
140367.1. ACL basics
14037---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014038
14039The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14040content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14041from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14042simple :
14043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014044 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014045 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014046 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14047 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014049The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14050adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014051
14052In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014054 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014055
14056This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14057Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14058and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014059an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14060conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14061as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14062are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014063
14064ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14065'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14066which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14067
14068There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14069performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014071The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14072specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14073this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014074methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14075ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014076
14077Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14078 - boolean
14079 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14080 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14081 - string
14082 - data block
14083
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014084Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14085converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14086would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14087The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14088which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14089
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014090Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14091keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14092fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14093which are summarized in the table below :
14094
14095 +---------------------+-----------------+
14096 | Sample or converter | Default |
14097 | output type | matching method |
14098 +---------------------+-----------------+
14099 | boolean | bool |
14100 +---------------------+-----------------+
14101 | integer | int |
14102 +---------------------+-----------------+
14103 | ip | ip |
14104 +---------------------+-----------------+
14105 | string | str |
14106 +---------------------+-----------------+
14107 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14108 +---------------------+-----------------+
14109
14110Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14111matching method, see below.
14112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014113The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14114 - boolean
14115 - integer or integer range
14116 - IP address / network
14117 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14118 - regular expression
14119 - hex block
14120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014121The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14122
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014123 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14124 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014126 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014127 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014128 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014129 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014131The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14132read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14133if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14134lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14135will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14136beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14137a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14138lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14139exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14140
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014141The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14142parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14143ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14144a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14145check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14146
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014147The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14148socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14149file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014151Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14152loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14153
14154 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14155
14156In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14157the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14158case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14159as well.
14160
14161The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14162sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14163do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14164methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14165is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014166obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014167followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14168default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14169that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14170string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14171
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014172The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14173By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14174string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14175resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14176server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014177waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014178flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14179function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014181There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14182sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14183be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014184
14185 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14186 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014187 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14188 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14189 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14190 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014191
14192 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14193 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014194 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014195
14196 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014197 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014198
14199 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014200 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014201
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014202 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014203 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14204
14205 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14206 binary or string samples.
14207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014208 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14209 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014211 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14212 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14213 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14216 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014218 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14219 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014221 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14222 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14225 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014226 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014228 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14229 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14230 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014231
14232For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14233request, it is possible to do :
14234
14235 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14236
14237In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14238buffer, one would use the following acl :
14239
14240 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14241
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014242On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14243possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14244
14245 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14248criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14249method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14250to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14251criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14252the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014255the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14256For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014258 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14259 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14260 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14261 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014262
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014263
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014264The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14265types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14266combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14267brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14268default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270 +-------------------------------------------------+
14271 | Input sample type |
14272 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014273 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014274 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14275 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14276 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014277 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014279 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014281 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014282 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014283 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014284 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014285 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014286 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014287 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014288 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014289 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014291 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014292 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014293 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014294 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014295 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014296 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014297 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014298 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14299 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14300 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014301
14302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143037.1.1. Matching booleans
14304------------------------
14305
14306In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14307Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14308When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14309that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14310
14311Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14312return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14313"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14314
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143167.1.2. Matching integers
14317------------------------
14318
14319Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14320enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14321to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14322
14323Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14324matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14325lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014326
14327For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14328unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14329representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14330
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014331As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14332two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14333instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14334ranges and operators.
14335
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014336For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014337operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14338Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14339of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014341Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014342
14343 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14344 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14345 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14346 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14347 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14348
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014349For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014350
14351 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14352
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014353This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14354
14355 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14356
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143587.1.3. Matching strings
14359-----------------------
14360
14361String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14362different forms :
14363
14364 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014365 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014366
14367 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014368 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369
14370 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14371 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14372
14373 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14374 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14375
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014376 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14378 matches.
14379
14380 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14381 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14382 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014383
14384String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14385exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14386characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14387string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14388to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014389before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014390
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014391Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14392(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14393Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14394
14395Example:
14396 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14397 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14398
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144007.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14401---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014402
14403Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14404they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14405possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14406passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14407the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014408the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14409match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014410
14411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144127.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14413-------------------------------------
14414
14415It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14416not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14417a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14418to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14419digits may be used upper or lower case.
14420
14421Example :
14422 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14423 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14424
14425
144267.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14427---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014428
14429IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14430netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14431within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014432host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014433difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14434at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14435does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14436parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014437
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014438The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14439abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14440
14441 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14442 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14443 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14444 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14445 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14446 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14447 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14448 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14449
14450Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14451192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14452
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014453IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14454Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14455trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14456IPv6 patterns.
14457
14458HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14459following situations :
14460 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14461 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14462 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14463 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14464 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14465 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14466 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14467 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14468 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14469 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014471
144727.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14473----------------------------------
14474
14475Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14476combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14477
14478 - AND (implicit)
14479 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14480 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014484 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014486Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14487indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014489For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14490"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14491requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14492is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14493
14494 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014495 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14496 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14497 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014498
14499To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14500and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14501
14502 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14503 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14504 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14505 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14506
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014507 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014508 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14509 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14510 use_backend www if host_www
14511
14512It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14513expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14514be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14515the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14516
14517 The following rule :
14518
14519 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014520 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014521
14522 Can also be written that way :
14523
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014524 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525
14526It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14527to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14528simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14529sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14530good use is the following :
14531
14532 With named ACLs :
14533
14534 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14535 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14536 monitor fail if site_dead
14537
14538 With anonymous ACLs :
14539
14540 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14541
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014542See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14543keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014544
14545
145467.3. Fetching samples
14547---------------------
14548
14549Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14550against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14551sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14552ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14553of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14554available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14555
14556This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14557Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14558compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14559deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14560
14561The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14562matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14563method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14564indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14565
14566As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14567when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14568mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14569the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14570ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14571
14572Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14573multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14574when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014575incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14576are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014577is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14578all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14579
14580Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14581 - name
14582 - name(arg1)
14583 - name(arg1,arg2)
14584
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014585
145867.3.1. Converters
14587-----------------
14588
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014589Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14590of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14591is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14592was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014593has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014594unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14595
14596These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14597sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14598the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014599support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014600
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014601A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14602support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14603supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14604(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14605bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014607The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014608
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001460951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14610 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14611 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14612 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14613 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14614 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14615
14616 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014617 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14618 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014619 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14620 frontend http-in
14621 bind *:8081
14622 default_backend servers
14623 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14624 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14625
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014626add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014627 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014628 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014629 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14630 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014631 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014632 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14633 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14634 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14635 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014636 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014637 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014638
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014639aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14640 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14641 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14642 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14643 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14644 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14645 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14646
14647 Example:
14648 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14649 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14650
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014651and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014652 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014653 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014654 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14655 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014656 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014657 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14658 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14659 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14660 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014661 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014662 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014663
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014664b64dec
14665 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14666 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14667
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014668base64
14669 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014670 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014671 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14672
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014673bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014674 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014675 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014676 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014677 presence of a flag).
14678
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014679bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14680 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14681 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014682 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014683
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014684concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14685 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14686 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14687 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14688 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14689 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14690 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14691 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14692 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14693 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14694 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014695 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14696 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14697 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14698 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014699
14700 Example:
14701 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14702 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14703 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014704 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014705 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14706
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014707cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014708 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14709 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014710
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014711crc32([<avalanche>])
14712 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14713 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14714 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14715 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14716 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14717 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14718 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14719 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14720 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14721 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014722 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14723
14724crc32c([<avalanche>])
14725 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14726 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14727 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14728 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14729 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14730 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14731 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14732 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014733
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014734cut_crlf
14735 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14736 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14737 updated.
14738
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014739da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014740 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14741 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14742 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14743 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014744 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014745 configuration language.
14746
14747 Example:
14748 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014749 bind *:8881
14750 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014751 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014752
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014753debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14754 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14755 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14756 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14757 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14758 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14759 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14760 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14761 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14762 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14763 printable sample types.
14764
14765 Example:
14766 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014767
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014768digest(<algorithm>)
14769 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14770 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14771
14772 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14773 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14774
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014775div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014776 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14777 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014778 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014779 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14780 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014781 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014782 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14783 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14784 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14785 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014786 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014787 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014788
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014789djb2([<avalanche>])
14790 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14791 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14792 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14793 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14794 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14795 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14796 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014797 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14798 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014799
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014800even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014801 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014802 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14803
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014804field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14805 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14806 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14807 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14808 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14809 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14810 fields.
14811
14812 Example :
14813 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14814 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14815 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14816 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14817 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014818
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014819hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014820 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014821 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014822 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014823 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014824
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014825hex2i
14826 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014827 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014828
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014829htonl
14830 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14831 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14832 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14833 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14834
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014835hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14836 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14837 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14838 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14839 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14840
14841 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14842 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14843
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014844http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014845 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14846 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014847 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14848 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14849 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14850 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14851 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14852 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14853 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14854 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014856in_table(<table>)
14857 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14858 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14859 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014860 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014861 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14862
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014863ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14864 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014865 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014866 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14867 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14868 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14869 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14870 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014871
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014872json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014873 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014874 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014875 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014876 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14877 of errors:
14878 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14879 bytes, ...)
14880 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14881 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14882
14883 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14884 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14885 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14886 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14887 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14888 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014889 - "ascii" : never fails;
14890 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14891 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014892 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014893 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014894 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14895 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14896
14897 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014898 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014899
14900 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014901 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014902 capture request header user-agent len 150
14903 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014904
14905 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14906 GET / HTTP/1.0
14907 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14908
14909 Output log:
14910 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14911
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014912language(<value>[,<default>])
14913 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14914 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14915 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14916 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14917 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14918 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14919 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14920 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14921 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014922 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014923 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14924 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014925
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014926 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014927
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014928 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14929 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014930
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014931 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14932 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14933 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14934 use_backend spanish if es
14935 use_backend french if fr
14936 use_backend english if en
14937 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014938
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014939length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014940 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14941 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14942 type. The result is of type integer.
14943
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014944lower
14945 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14946 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14947 type. The result is of type string.
14948
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014949ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14950 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14951 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14952 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14953 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14954 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14955 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14956
14957 Example :
14958
14959 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014960 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014961 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14962
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014963ltrim(<chars>)
14964 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14965 representation of the input sample.
14966
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014967map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14968map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14969map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14970 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14971 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14972 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14973 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14974 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14975 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14976 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14977 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014978
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014979 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14980 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14981 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014982
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014983 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014984 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014985
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014986 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14987 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14988 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14989 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014990 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14991 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014992 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14993 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14994 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14995 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14996 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14997 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14998 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14999 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015000 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15001 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15002 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015003 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15004 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15005 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15006 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15007 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015008
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015009 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15010 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15011 the corresponding match text.
15012
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015013 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15014 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15015 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15016 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15017 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015018
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015019 Example :
15020
15021 # this is a comment and is ignored
15022 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15023 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15024 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15025 | | | `---------- value
15026 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15027 | `---------------------------- key
15028 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15029
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015030mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015031 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15032 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015033 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015034 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015035 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015036 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15037 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15038 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15039 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015040 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015041 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015042
15043mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015044 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015045 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15046 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015047 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015048 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015049 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015050 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15051 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15052 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15053 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015054 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015055 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015056
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015057nbsrv
15058 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15059 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15060 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15061 map lookup.
15062
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015063neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015064 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15065 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15066 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15067 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015068
15069not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015070 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015071 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015072 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015073 absence of a flag).
15074
15075odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015076 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015077 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15078
15079or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015080 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015081 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015082 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15083 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015084 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015085 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15086 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15087 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15088 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015089 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015090 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015091
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015092protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15093 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15094 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15095 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15096 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15097 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15098 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15099 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15100 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15101 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15102 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15103 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15104
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015105regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015106 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15107 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15108 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15109 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15110 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15111 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15112 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15113 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15114 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015115 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15116 of characters with other ones.
15117
15118 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15119 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15120 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15121 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15122 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15123 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015124
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015125 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015126
15127 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15128 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15129 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015130 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015131
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015132 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15133 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15134
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015135 # capture groups and backreferences
15136 # both lines do the same.
15137 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15138 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15139
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015140capture-req(<id>)
15141 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15142 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15143
15144 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015145 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15146 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015147
15148capture-res(<id>)
15149 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15150 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15151
15152 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015153 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15154 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015155
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015156rtrim(<chars>)
15157 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15158 of the input sample.
15159
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015160sdbm([<avalanche>])
15161 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15162 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15163 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15164 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15165 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15166 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15167 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015168 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15169 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015170
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015171secure_memcmp(<var>)
15172 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15173 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15174 match.
15175
15176 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15177 performed in constant time.
15178
15179 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15180 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15181
15182 Example :
15183
15184 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15185 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15186 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15187 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15188
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015189set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015190 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15191 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15192 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015193 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015194 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15195 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015196 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015197 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15198 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015199 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015200 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015201
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015202sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015203 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015204 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15205
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015206sha2([<bits>])
15207 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15208 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15209
15210 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15211 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15212
15213 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15214 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15215
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015216srv_queue
15217 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15218 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15219 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15220 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15221 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15222
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015223strcmp(<var>)
15224 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15225 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15226 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15227 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15228 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15229 shorter).
15230
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015231 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15232 strings in constant time.
15233
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015234 Example :
15235
15236 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15237 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15238 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15239
15240
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015241sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015242 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15243 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015244 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015245 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15246 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015247 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015248 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15249 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015250 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015251 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15252 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015253 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015254 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015255
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015256table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15257 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15258 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15259 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15260 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15261 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15262 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15263
15264
15265table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15266 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15267 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15268 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15269 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15270 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15271 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15272
15273table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15274 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15275 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015276 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015277 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15278 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15279
15280table_conn_cur(<table>)
15281 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15282 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15283 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15284 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15285 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15286
15287table_conn_rate(<table>)
15288 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15289 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15290 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15291 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15292 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15293
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015294table_gpt0(<table>)
15295 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15296 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15297 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15298 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15299 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15300
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015301table_gpc0(<table>)
15302 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15303 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15304 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15305 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15306 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15307
15308table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15309 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15310 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15311 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15312 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15313 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15314 sample fetch keyword.
15315
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015316table_gpc1(<table>)
15317 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15318 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15319 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15320 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15321 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15322
15323table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15324 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15325 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15326 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15327 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15328 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15329 sample fetch keyword.
15330
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015331table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15332 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15333 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015334 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015335 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15336 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15337
15338table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15339 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15340 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15341 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15342 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15343 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15344 keyword.
15345
15346table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15347 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15348 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015349 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015350 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15351 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15352
15353table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15354 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15355 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15356 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15357 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15358 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15359 keyword.
15360
15361table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15362 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15363 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015364 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015365 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15366 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15367 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15368 keyword.
15369
15370table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15371 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15372 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015373 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015374 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15375 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15376 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15377 keyword.
15378
15379table_server_id(<table>)
15380 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15381 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15382 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15383 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15384 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15385 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15386
15387table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15388 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15389 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015390 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015391 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15392 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15393 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15394 keyword.
15395
15396table_sess_rate(<table>)
15397 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15398 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15399 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15400 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15401 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15402 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15403 keyword.
15404
15405table_trackers(<table>)
15406 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15407 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15408 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15409 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15410 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15411 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15412 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15413 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15414 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15415 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15416
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015417upper
15418 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15419 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15420 type. The result is of type string.
15421
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015422url_dec([<in_form>])
15423 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15424 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15425 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15426 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15427 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15428 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015429
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015430ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015431 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015432 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15433 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15434 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015435 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15436 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15437 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15438 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015439 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015440 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15441 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015442
15443 Example:
15444 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15445 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15446
15447 message Point {
15448 int32 latitude = 1;
15449 int32 longitude = 2;
15450 }
15451
15452 message PPoint {
15453 Point point = 59;
15454 }
15455
15456 message Rectangle {
15457 // One corner of the rectangle.
15458 PPoint lo = 48;
15459 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15460 PPoint hi = 49;
15461 }
15462
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015463 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15464 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15465 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015466
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015467 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15468 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015469 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015470 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15471
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015472 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015473
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015474 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015475
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015476 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15477 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15478 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015479
15480 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15481 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15482 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15483
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015484 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15485 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15486 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015487
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015488
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015489unset-var(<var name>)
15490 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15491 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15492 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15493 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15494 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15495 response),
15496 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15497 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15498 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15499 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15500
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015501utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15502 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15503 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15504 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15505 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15506 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15507 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15508
15509 Example :
15510
15511 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015512 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015513 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15514
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015515word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15516 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15517 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15518 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015519 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015520 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15521 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15522
15523 Example :
15524 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15525 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15526 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15527 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15528 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015529 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015530
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015531wt6([<avalanche>])
15532 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15533 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15534 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15535 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15536 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15537 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15538 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015539 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15540 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015541
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015542xor(<value>)
15543 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015544 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015545 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015546 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015547 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015548 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15549 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015550 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015551 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15552 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015553 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015554 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015555
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015556xxh32([<seed>])
15557 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15558 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15559 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15560 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15561 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15562 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15563 as cryptographically secure.
15564
15565xxh64([<seed>])
15566 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15567 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15568 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15569 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15570 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15571 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15572 as cryptographically secure.
15573
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576--------------------------------------------
15577
15578A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15579not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15580"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15581The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15582
15583always_false : boolean
15584 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15585 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15586
15587always_true : boolean
15588 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15589 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15590
15591avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015592 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15594 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15595 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15596 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15597 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15598 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15599 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15600 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15601 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15602 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15603 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15604 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15605 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015608 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15609 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15610 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15611 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015612 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15613
15614be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15615 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15616 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15617 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15618 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15619 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015620 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15621 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015622
15623 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15624 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15625 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015627be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15628 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15629 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15630 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015631 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015632 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15633 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015634
15635 Example :
15636 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15637 backend dynamic
15638 mode http
15639 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15640 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015641
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015642bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015643 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15644 of the string.
15645
15646bool(<bool>) : bool
15647 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15648 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15651 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015652 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15654 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015655
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015656 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015657 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015658 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15659
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015660 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15661 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015662
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015663 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015664 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015666 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015667 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015669 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015670
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015671 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15672 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015674 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015675
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015676cpu_calls : integer
15677 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15678 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15679 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15680 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15681 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15682 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15683
15684cpu_ns_avg : integer
15685 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15686 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15687 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15688 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15689 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15690 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15691 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15692 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15693 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15694 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15695 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15696
15697cpu_ns_tot : integer
15698 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15699 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15700 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15701 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15702 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15703 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15704 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15705 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15706 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15707 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15708 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15709 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15710 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15711
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015712date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015713 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015714
15715 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15716 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15717 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015718 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15719
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015720 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15721 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15722 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15723 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15724 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15725
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015726 Example :
15727
15728 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15729 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015730
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015731 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15732 # millisecond granularity
15733 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15734
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015735date_us : integer
15736 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15737 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15738 from the same timeval structure.
15739
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015740distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15741 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15742 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15743 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15744 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15745 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15746 list of supported tokens.
15747
15748distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15749 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15750 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15751 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15752 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15753 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15754 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15755 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15756 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15757 supported tokens.
15758
15759 Example :
15760 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15761 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15762 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15763 # send large files to the big farm
15764 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15765
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015766env(<name>) : string
15767 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15768 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15769 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15770 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15771 certain way.
15772
15773 Examples :
15774 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15775 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15776
15777 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15778 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15781 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015782 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15783 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015784 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15785 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015786 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015787 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15788 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015789
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015790fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15791 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15792 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15793 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015795fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15796 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15797 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15798 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15799 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15800 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15801 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15802 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15803 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015804
15805 Example :
15806 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15807 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15808 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15809 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15810 frontend mail
15811 bind :25
15812 mode tcp
15813 maxconn 100
15814 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15815 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15816 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15817 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015818
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015819hostname : string
15820 Returns the system hostname.
15821
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015822int(<integer>) : signed integer
15823 Returns a signed integer.
15824
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015825ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15826 Returns an ipv4.
15827
15828ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15829 Returns an ipv6.
15830
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015831lat_ns_avg : integer
15832 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15833 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15834 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15835 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15836 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15837 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15838 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15839 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15840 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15841 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15842 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15843 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15844 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15845 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15846
15847lat_ns_tot : integer
15848 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15849 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15850 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15851 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15852 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15853 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15854 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15855 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15856 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15857 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15858 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15859 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15860 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15861 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15862 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15863 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15864 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15865 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15866 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15867
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015868meth(<method>) : method
15869 Returns a method.
15870
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015871nbproc : integer
15872 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15873 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15874 and debugging purposes.
15875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15877 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15878 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15879 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015880 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15881 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15882 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015883
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015884prio_class : integer
15885 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15886 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15887 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15888
15889prio_offset : integer
15890 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15891 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15892 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15893 set-priority-offset".
15894
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015895proc : integer
15896 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15897 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15898 debugging purposes.
15899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015901 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15902 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15903 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15905 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15906 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15907 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15908 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15909
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015910rand([<range>]) : integer
15911 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15912 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15913 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15914 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15915 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15916
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015917uuid([<version>]) : string
15918 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15919 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15920 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15923 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15924 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15925 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15926 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15927 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015928 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15929 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15930
15931srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15932 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15933 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15934 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15935 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15936 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15937 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15938 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15939
15940 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15941 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942
15943srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15944 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15945 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15946 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015947 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15949 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15950 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15951
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015952srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15953 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15954 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15955 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15956 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15957 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15958 fetch methods.
15959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15961 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15962 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015963 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15965 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015966 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967 overloading servers).
15968
15969 Example :
15970 # Redirect to a separate back
15971 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15972 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15973 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15974
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015975stopping : boolean
15976 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15977 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15978 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15979
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015980str(<string>) : string
15981 Returns a string.
15982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015983table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15984 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15985 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15986
15987table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15988 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15989 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15990 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15991
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015992thread : integer
15993 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15994 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15995 and debugging purposes.
15996
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015997var(<var-name>) : undefined
15998 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015999 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16000 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016001 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016002 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16003 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016004 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016005 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16006 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016007 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016008 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160107.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011----------------------------------
16012
16013The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16014closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16015methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16016sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16017TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016018the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16019counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016020"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16021used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16022can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16023Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16024table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16025tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16026currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016028bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016029 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16030 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16031 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016033be_id : integer
16034 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016035 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16036 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016038be_name : string
16039 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016040 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16041 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043dst : ip
16044 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16045 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16046 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16047 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016048 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16049 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16050 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16051 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16052 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16053 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054
16055dst_conn : integer
16056 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16057 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16058 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16059 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16060 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16061 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16062 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16063 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016064
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016065dst_is_local : boolean
16066 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16067 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16068 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16069 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016070 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016071 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16072 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16073 it only once per connection.
16074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075dst_port : integer
16076 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16077 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16078 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16079 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16080 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16081 an HTTP header.
16082
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016083fc_http_major : integer
16084 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16085 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16086 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16087
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016088fc_pp_authority : string
16089 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16090 if any.
16091
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016092fc_pp_unique_id : string
16093 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16094 if any.
16095
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016096fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16097 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16098 header.
16099
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016100fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16101 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16102 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16103 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16104 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16105 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16106 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16107
16108fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16109 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16110 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16111 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16112 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16113 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16114 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16115
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016116fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016117 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16118 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16119 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16120 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16121
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016122fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016123 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16124 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16125 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16126 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16127
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016128fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016129 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16130 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16131 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16132 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16133
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016134fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016135 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16136 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16137 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16138 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16139
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016140fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016141 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16142 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16143 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16144 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16145
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016146fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016147 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16148 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16149 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16150 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16151
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016152fe_defbe : string
16153 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16154 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156fe_id : integer
16157 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016158 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16160
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016161fe_name : string
16162 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16163 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16164 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16165
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016166sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016167sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16168sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16169sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016170 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16171 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16172 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16173
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016174sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016175sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16176sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16177sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016178 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16179 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16180 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16181
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016182sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016183sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16184sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16185sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016186 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16187 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016188 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16189 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16190 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016191
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016192 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016193 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16194 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016195 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16196 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16197 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016198 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16199 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16200
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016201sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16202sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16203sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16204sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16205 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16206 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16207 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16208 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16209 when a first ACL was verified.
16210
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016211sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016212sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16213sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16214sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016215 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016216 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16217
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016218sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016219sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16220sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16221sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016222 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16223 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16224 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16225
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016226sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016227sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16228sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16229sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016230 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16231 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16232 See also src_conn_rate.
16233
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016234sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016235sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16236sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16237sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016238 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016239 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016240
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016241sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16242sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16243sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16244sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16245 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16246 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16247
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016248sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16249sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16250sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16251sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16252 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16253 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16254
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016255sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016256sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16257sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16258sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016259 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16260 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16261 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016262 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16263 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16264 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016265
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016266sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16267sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16268sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16269sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16270 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16271 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16272 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16273 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16274 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16275 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16276
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016277sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016278sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16279sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16280sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016281 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016282 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16283 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16284
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016285sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016286sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16287sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16288sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016289 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16290 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16291 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16292 src_http_err_rate.
16293
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016294sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016295sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16296sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16297sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016298 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016299 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16300 src_http_req_cnt.
16301
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016302sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016303sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16304sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16305sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016306 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16307 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16308 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16309 src_http_req_rate.
16310
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016311sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016312sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16313sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16314sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016315 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016316 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16317 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16318 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16319 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016320
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016321 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016322 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16323 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016324 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16325
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016326sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16327sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16328sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16329sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16330 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16331 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16332 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16333 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16334 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016336sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016337sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16338sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16339sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016340 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16341 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16342 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016343
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016344sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016345sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16346sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16347sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016348 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16349 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16350 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016352sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016353sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16354sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16355sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016356 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016357 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16358 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16359 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016360 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016361 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16362
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016363sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016364sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16365sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16366sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016367 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16368 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16369 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16370 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16371 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016372 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016373
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016374sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016375sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16376sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16377sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016378 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16379 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16380 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16381
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016382sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016383sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16384sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16385sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016386 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16387 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016388 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016389 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16390 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016391 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16392 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16393 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395so_id : integer
16396 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16397 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16398 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016399
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016400so_name : string
16401 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16402 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16403 strings instead of integers.
16404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016405src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016406 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016407 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16408 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16409 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016410 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16411 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16412 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016413 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16414 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16415 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16416 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16417 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16418 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16419 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016420
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016421 Example:
16422 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16423 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016425src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16426 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16427 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16428 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016429 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016431src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16432 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16433 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016434 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016435 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016437src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16438 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16439 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16440 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16441 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16442 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16443 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016444
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016445 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016446 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16447 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16448 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16449 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016450 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016451 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16452 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16453
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016454src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16455 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16456 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16457 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16458 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16459 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16460 was verified.
16461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016462src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016463 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016464 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016465 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016466 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016468src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016469 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016470 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16471 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016472 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016474src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16475 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16476 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16477 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016478 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016481 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016482 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016483 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016484 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016485
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016486src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16487 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16488 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16489 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16490 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16491
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016492src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16493 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16494 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16495 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16496 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016498src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016499 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016500 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016501 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16502 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016503 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16504 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16505 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016506
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016507src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16508 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16509 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16510 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16511 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16512 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16513 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16514 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016516src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016517 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016518 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016519 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016520 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016521 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16524 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16525 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16526 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16527 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016528 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016530src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016531 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016532 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16533 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016534 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16537 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16538 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16539 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016540 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016541 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16544 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16545 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16546 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016547 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016548 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16549 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016550
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016551 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016552 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016553 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016554 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016555
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016556src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16557 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16558 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16559 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16560 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16561 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16562 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16563
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016564src_is_local : boolean
16565 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16566 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16567 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16568 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016569 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016570 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16571 once per connection.
16572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016573src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016574 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16575 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16576 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16577 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16578 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016581 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16582 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16583 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16584 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16585 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016587src_port : integer
16588 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16589 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16590 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16591 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016594 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016595 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16596 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16597 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016598 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16601 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16602 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16603 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16604 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016605 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016607src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16608 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16609 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16610 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16611 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16612 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16613 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16614 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16615 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016616
16617 Example :
16618 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16619 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16620 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16621 listen ssh
16622 bind :22
16623 mode tcp
16624 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016625 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016626 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016627 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016629srv_id : integer
16630 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16631 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016632 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016633
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016634srv_name : string
16635 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16636 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016637 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016638
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166397.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016640----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016642The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16643closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16644when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16645usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016646future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016647
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001664851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16649 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16650 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16651 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16652 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16653 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16654
16655 Example :
16656 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16657 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16658 # the request.
16659 frontend http-in
16660 bind *:8081
16661 default_backend servers
16662 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16663 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16664
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016665ssl_bc : boolean
16666 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16667 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016668 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16669 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016670
16671ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16672 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016673 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16674 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016675
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016676ssl_bc_alpn : string
16677 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16678 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016679 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016680 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16681 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16682 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16683 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16684 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016685 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16686 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016687
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016688ssl_bc_cipher : string
16689 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016690 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16691 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016692
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016693ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16694 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16695 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16696 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016697 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016698
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016699ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16700 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16701 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016702 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16703 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016704
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016705ssl_bc_npn : string
16706 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16707 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016708 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016709 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16710 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16711 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16712 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016713 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16714 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016715
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016716ssl_bc_protocol : string
16717 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016718 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16719 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016720
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016721ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016722 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016723 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016724 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16725 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016726
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016727ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16728 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16729 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16730 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016731 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016732
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016733ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16734 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16735 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016736 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16737 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016738
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016739ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16740 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16741 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16742 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016743 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016744
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016745ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16746 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016747 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16748 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016750ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16751 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16752 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16753 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16754 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16755 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016757ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16758 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16759 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16760 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16761 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016762
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016763ssl_c_der : binary
16764 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16765 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16766 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768ssl_c_err : integer
16769 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16770 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16771 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16772 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16773 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016774
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016775ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16777 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16778 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16779 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16780 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16781 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16782 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16783 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016784 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16785 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16786 LDAP v3.
16787 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16788 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016790ssl_c_key_alg : string
16791 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16792 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16793 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795ssl_c_notafter : string
16796 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16797 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16798 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016800ssl_c_notbefore : string
16801 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16802 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16803 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016804
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016805ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16807 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16808 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16809 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16810 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16811 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16812 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16813 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016814 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16815 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16816 LDAP v3.
16817 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16818 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820ssl_c_serial : binary
16821 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16822 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16823 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016825ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16826 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16827 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16828 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016829 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16830 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16831
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016832 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016833 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016835ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16836 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16837 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16838 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016840ssl_c_used : boolean
16841 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16842 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016844ssl_c_verify : integer
16845 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16846 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16847 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16848 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016850ssl_c_version : integer
16851 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16852 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016853
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016854ssl_f_der : binary
16855 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16856 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16857 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16858
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016859ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016860 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16861 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16862 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16863 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016864 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016865 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16866 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16867 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016868 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16869 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16870 LDAP v3.
16871 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16872 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016874ssl_f_key_alg : string
16875 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16876 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16877 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016879ssl_f_notafter : string
16880 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16881 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16882 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016884ssl_f_notbefore : string
16885 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16886 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16887 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016888
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016889ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16891 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16892 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16893 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16894 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16895 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16896 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16897 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016898 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16899 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16900 LDAP v3.
16901 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16902 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904ssl_f_serial : binary
16905 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16906 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16907 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016908
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016909ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16910 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16911 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16912 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016914ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16915 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16916 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16917 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016919ssl_f_version : integer
16920 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16921 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16922
16923ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016924 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16925 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16926 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016928 Example :
16929 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16930 listen http-https
16931 bind :80
16932 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16933 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16934
16935ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16936 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16937 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16938
16939ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016940 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016941 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16942 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16943 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16944 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16945 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16946 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16947 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16948 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016950ssl_fc_cipher : string
16951 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16952 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016953
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016954ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16955 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16956 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016957 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016958
16959ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16960 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16961 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016962 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016963
16964ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16965 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16966 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16967 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016968 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016969 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016970
16971ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16972 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16973 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016974 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016975
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016976ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16977 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16978 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16979 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016981ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016982 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16983 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016984 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16985 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16986 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16987 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016988
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016989ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16990 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16991 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16992 wait until the handshake happened.
16993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016994ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16995 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016996 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16997 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016998 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016999 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017000
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017001ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017002 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017003 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17004 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017006ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017007 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017008 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17009 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17010 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17011 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17012 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17013 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17014 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017016ssl_fc_protocol : string
17017 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17018 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017019
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017020ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017021 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017022 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17023 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017024
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017025ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17026 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17027 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17028 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017030ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17031 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17032 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17033 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17034 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017035
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017036ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17037 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17038 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17039 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17040 BoringSSL.
17041
17042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017043ssl_fc_sni : string
17044 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17045 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17046 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17047 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17048 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17049
17050 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17051 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17052 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017053 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017054 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017056 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017057 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17058 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017060ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17061 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17062 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017063
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017064
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170657.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017066------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017068Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17069sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17070only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17071For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17072be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17073can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17074sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17075for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17076content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017078payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017079 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017080 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17081 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017083payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17084 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017085 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017086 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017087
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017088req.hdrs : string
17089 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17090 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17091 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17092 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17093
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017094req.hdrs_bin : binary
17095 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17096 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17097 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17098 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17099 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17100 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17101
17102 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17103
17104 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17105 str: <int:length><bytes>
17106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017107req.len : integer
17108req_len : integer (deprecated)
17109 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17110 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17111 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17112 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17113 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17114 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17115 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17116 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017118req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17119 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017120 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17121 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17122 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17123 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017125 ACL alternatives :
17126 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017128req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17129 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17130 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17131 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17132 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017134 ACL alternatives :
17135 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017139req.proto_http : boolean
17140req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17141 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17142 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17143 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17144 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17145 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17146 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17147 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017149 Example:
17150 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17151 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17152 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017153 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17156rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17157 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17158 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17159 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17160 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17161 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17162 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17163 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017165 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17166 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17167 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17168 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17169 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17170 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017172 ACL derivatives :
17173 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017175 Example :
17176 listen tse-farm
17177 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17178 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17179 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17180 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17181 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17182 persist rdp-cookie
17183 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17184 # This is only useful makes sense if
17185 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17186 stick-table type string size 204800
17187 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17188 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17189 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017191 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17192 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017194req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17195rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17196 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17197 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17198 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17199 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017201 ACL derivatives :
17202 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017203
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017204req.ssl_alpn : string
17205 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17206 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17207 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17208 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17209 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17210 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017211 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017212
17213 Examples :
17214 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17215 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17216 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017217 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017218 default_backend bk_default
17219
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017220req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17221 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17222 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017223 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17224 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17225 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17226 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17227 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017229req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17230req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17231 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17232 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17233 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17234 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17235 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17236 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17237 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017239req.ssl_sni : string
17240req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17241 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17242 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17243 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17244 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17245 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17246 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17247 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17248 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17249 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17250 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17251 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17252 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017254 ACL derivatives :
17255 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017257 Examples :
17258 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17259 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17260 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17261 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17262 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017263
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017264req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17265 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17266 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17267 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17268 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17269 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17270 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17271 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17272 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17273 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017275req.ssl_ver : integer
17276req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17277 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17278 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17279 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17280 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17281 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17282 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17283 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017284 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287 ACL derivatives :
17288 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017289
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017290res.len : integer
17291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17292 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17293 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17294 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17295 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17296 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17297 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017298 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017300res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17301 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017302 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017303 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017304 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017305 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017307res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17308 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17309 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17310 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017311 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17312 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017314 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017315
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017316res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17317rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17318 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17319 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17320 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17321 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17322 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17323 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17324 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017326wait_end : boolean
17327 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17328 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017329 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017330 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17331 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017332 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017333 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17334 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017336 Examples :
17337 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17338 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17339 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017341 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17342 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17343 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17344 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17345 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17346 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17347 tcp-request content reject
17348
17349
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173507.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351--------------------------------------
17352
17353It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17354This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17355data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17356its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17357HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17358content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17359to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17360more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17361response are indexed.
17362
17363base : string
17364 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17365 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17366 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17367 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17368 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17369 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17370 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17371 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17372
17373 ACL derivatives :
17374 base : exact string match
17375 base_beg : prefix match
17376 base_dir : subdir match
17377 base_dom : domain match
17378 base_end : suffix match
17379 base_len : length match
17380 base_reg : regex match
17381 base_sub : substring match
17382
17383base32 : integer
17384 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17385 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17386 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017387 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17388 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17389 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017390
17391base32+src : binary
17392 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17393 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17394 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17395 per-URL counters.
17396
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017397capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17398 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17399 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17400 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17401
17402capture.req.method : string
17403 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17404 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17405 because it's allocated.
17406
17407capture.req.uri : string
17408 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17409 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17410 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17411 allocated.
17412
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017413capture.req.ver : string
17414 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17415 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17416 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17417
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017418capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17419 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17420 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17421 The first entry is an index of 0.
17422 See also: "capture response header"
17423
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017424capture.res.ver : string
17425 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17426 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17427 persistent flag.
17428
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017429req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017430 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17431 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17432 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017433
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017434req.body_param([<name>) : string
17435 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17436 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17437 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17438 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17439 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17440 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17441 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17442 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17443 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17444 given.
17445
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017446req.body_len : integer
17447 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17448 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017449 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17450 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017451
17452req.body_size : integer
17453 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017454 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17455 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017457req.cook([<name>]) : string
17458cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17459 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17460 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17461 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17462 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17463 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17464 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17465 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17466 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17467
17468 ACL derivatives :
17469 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17470 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17471 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17472 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17473 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17474 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17475 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17476 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017478req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17479cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17480 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17481 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017483req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17484cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17485 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17486 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17487 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17488 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17491 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17492 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17493 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17494 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017495 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017496 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17497 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17498 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17499 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017501hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17502 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17503 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17504 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17505 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017506 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017508req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17509 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17510 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17511 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17512 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17513 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17514 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17515 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17516 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017518req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17519 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17520 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17521 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17522 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17525 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17526 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17527 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17528 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17529 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17530 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17531 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17532 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017533 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017534 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017535 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017537 ACL derivatives :
17538 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17539 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17540 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17541 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17542 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17543 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17544 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17545 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17546
17547req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17548hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17549 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17550 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17551 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17552 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17553 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17554 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17555 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17556 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17557 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17558
17559req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17560hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17561 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17562 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17563 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17564 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17565 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017566 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017567 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17568 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17569
17570req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17571hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17572 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17573 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17574 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17575 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17576 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17577 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17578 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17579
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017580
17581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017582http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17583 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17584 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17585 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17586 basic auth is supported.
17587
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017588http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17589 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17590 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17591 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17592 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017593 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17594 basic auth is supported.
17595
17596 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017597 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17598 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17599 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17600 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017601
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017602http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017603 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17604 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17605 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017606
17607http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017608 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17609 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17610 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017611
17612http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017613 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17614 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17615 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017617http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017618 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17619 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017620 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17621 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017623method : integer + string
17624 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17625 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17626 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17627 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17628 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17629 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17630 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017632 ACL derivatives :
17633 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017635 Example :
17636 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17637 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17638 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017640path : string
17641 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17642 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17643 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17644 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17645 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017646 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017647 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017649 ACL derivatives :
17650 path : exact string match
17651 path_beg : prefix match
17652 path_dir : subdir match
17653 path_dom : domain match
17654 path_end : suffix match
17655 path_len : length match
17656 path_reg : regex match
17657 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017658
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017659query : string
17660 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17661 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17662 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17663 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017664 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017665 which stops before the question mark.
17666
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017667req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17668 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17669 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17670 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17671 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017673req.ver : string
17674req_ver : string (deprecated)
17675 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17676 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17677 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017679 ACL derivatives :
17680 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017681
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017682res.body : binary
17683 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17684 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17685 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17686 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17687
17688res.body_len : integer
17689 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17690 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17691 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17692 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17693
17694res.body_size : integer
17695 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17696 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17697 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17698 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17699 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17700 based expect rules.
17701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017702res.comp : boolean
17703 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17704 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17705 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017707res.comp_algo : string
17708 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17709 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17710 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017712res.cook([<name>]) : string
17713scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17714 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17715 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017716 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17717 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017719 ACL derivatives :
17720 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017722res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17723scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17724 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17725 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017726 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17727 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017729res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17730scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17731 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17732 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017733 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17734 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017736res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17737 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17738 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17739 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17740 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17741 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17742 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17743 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17744 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017745 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17748 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17749 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17750 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17751 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017752 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17753 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017755res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17756shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17757 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17758 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17759 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17760 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17761 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17762 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17763 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017764 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17765 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017767 ACL derivatives :
17768 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17769 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17770 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17771 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17772 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17773 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17774 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17775 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17776
17777res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17778shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17779 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17780 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17781 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17782 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017783 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017785res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17786shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17787 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17788 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17789 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17790 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17791 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017792 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17793 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017794
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017795res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17796 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17797 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17798 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017799 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
17800 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017802res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17803shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17804 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17805 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17806 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17807 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17808 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017809 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
17810 based expect rules.
17811
17812res.hdrs : string
17813 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
17814 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17815 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17816 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
17817 based expect rules.
17818
17819res.hdrs_bin : binary
17820 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17821 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
17822 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
17823 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
17824 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
17825 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
17826 (length of 0 for both).
17827
17828 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17829
17830 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17831 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017833res.ver : string
17834resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17835 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017836 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
17837 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017839 ACL derivatives :
17840 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017842set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17843 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17844 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017845 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017846 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017848 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17849 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017851status : integer
17852 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17853 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017854 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
17855 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017856
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017857unique-id : string
17858 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17859 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17860 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17861 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17862 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17863 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017865url : string
17866 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17867 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17868 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17869 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17870 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17871 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17872 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017874 ACL derivatives :
17875 url : exact string match
17876 url_beg : prefix match
17877 url_dir : subdir match
17878 url_dom : domain match
17879 url_end : suffix match
17880 url_len : length match
17881 url_reg : regex match
17882 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017884url_ip : ip
17885 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17886 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17887 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17888 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17889 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17890 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17891 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017893url_port : integer
17894 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17895 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17896 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17897 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017898
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017899urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17900url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017901 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17902 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017903 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17904 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17905 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17906 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017907 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17908 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017909 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17910 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017912 ACL derivatives :
17913 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17914 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17915 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17916 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17917 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17918 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17919 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17920 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017921
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017923 Example :
17924 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17925 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17926 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17927 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017928
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017929urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017930 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17931 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17932 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017933
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017934url32 : integer
17935 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17936 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17937 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17938 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17939 is an unsigned integer.
17940
17941url32+src : binary
17942 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17943 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17944 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17945
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020017946
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200179477.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017948---------------------------------------
17949
17950This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17951used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17952purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17953There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17954or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17955any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17956for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17957
17958internal.htx.data : integer
17959 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17960 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17961
17962internal.htx.free : integer
17963 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17964 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17965
17966internal.htx.free_data : integer
17967 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17968 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17969
17970internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17971 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17972 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17973 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17974
17975internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17976 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17977 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17978
17979internal.htx.size : integer
17980 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17981 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17982
17983internal.htx.used : integer
17984 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17985 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17986 direction.
17987
17988internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17989 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17990 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17991 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17992 of the special value :
17993 * head : The oldest inserted block
17994 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017995 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017996
17997internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17998 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17999 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18000 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18001 integer or one of the special value :
18002 * head : The oldest inserted block
18003 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018004 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018005
18006internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18007 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18008 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18009 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18010 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18011
18012 * head : The oldest inserted block
18013 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018014 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018015
18016internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18017 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18018 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18019 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18020 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18021
18022 * head : The oldest inserted block
18023 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018024 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018025
18026internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18027 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18028 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18029 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18030 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18031
18032 * head : The oldest inserted block
18033 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018034 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018035
18036internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18037 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18038 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18039 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18040 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18041
18042 * head : The oldest inserted block
18043 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018044 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018045
18046internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18047 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18048 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18049 it returns false.
18050
18051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200180527.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018053---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018055Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18056every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018057order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018059ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18060---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018061FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018062HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018063HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18064HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018065HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18066HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18067HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18068HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18069LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018070METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018071METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018072METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18073METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18074METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18075METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018076METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018077METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018078RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018079REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018080TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018081WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18082---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018083
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180858. Logging
18086----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018087
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018088One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18089provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18090very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18091provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18092state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018093to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018094headers.
18095
18096In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18097about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18098send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18099
18100 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18101 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18102 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18103 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18104 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018105 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018106 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018107
18108The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18109allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18110as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18111while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18112real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18113delay.
18114
18115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181168.1. Log levels
18117---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018118
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018119TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018120source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018121HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18122in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18123track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18124syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18125about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018126
18127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181288.2. Log formats
18129----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018130
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018131HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018132and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18133slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18134options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018135
18136 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18137 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18138 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18139 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18140 extents.
18141
18142 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18143 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18144 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18145 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18146 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18147
18148 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18149 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18150 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18151 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18152 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18153
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018154 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18155 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18156 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18157 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18158
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018159 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018161Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18162specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18163field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18164servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18165always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18166identifier.
18167
18168Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18169 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18170 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18171 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18172 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18173
18174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181758.2.1. Default log format
18176-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018177
18178This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18179as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18180format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18181
18182 Example :
18183 listen www
18184 mode http
18185 log global
18186 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18187
18188 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18189 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18190 (www/HTTP)
18191
18192 Field Format Extract from the example above
18193 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18194 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18195 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18196 4 'to' to
18197 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18198 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18199
18200Detailed fields description :
18201 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18202 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18203 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18204 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18205 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18206 and processed the connection.
18207 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18208
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018209In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18210"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18211connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18212
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018213It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18214will eventually disappear.
18215
18216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182178.2.2. TCP log format
18218---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018219
18220The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18221is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18222information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18223counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18224emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18225environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18226the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18227sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018228specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18229not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18230fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18231marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018232
18233 Example :
18234 frontend fnt
18235 mode tcp
18236 option tcplog
18237 log global
18238 default_backend bck
18239
18240 backend bck
18241 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18242
18243 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18244 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18245 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18246
18247 Field Format Extract from the example above
18248 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18249 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18250 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18251 4 frontend_name fnt
18252 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18253 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18254 7 bytes_read* 212
18255 8 termination_state --
18256 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18257 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18258
18259Detailed fields description :
18260 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018261 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18262 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18263 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018264 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018265 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018266 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018267
18268 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018269 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18270 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18271 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018272
18273 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18274 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18275 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018276 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18277 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18278 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18279 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018280
18281 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18282 and processed the connection.
18283
18284 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18285 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18286 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18287 applications.
18288
18289 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18290 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18291 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18292 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18293 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18294
18295 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18296 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18297 See "Timers" below for more details.
18298
18299 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18300 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18301 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18302 "Timers" below for more details.
18303
18304 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018305 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018306 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18307 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18308 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18309 details.
18310
18311 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18312 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18313 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18314 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18315 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18316
18317 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18318 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18319 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18320 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18321 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18322 for more details.
18323
18324 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018325 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018326 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18327 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18328 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018329 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018330
18331 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18332 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18333 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18334 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18335 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18336 caused by a denial of service attack.
18337
18338 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18339 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18340 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18341 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18342 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18343 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18344 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18345 denial of service attack.
18346
18347 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18348 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18349 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18350 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18351 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18352 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18353 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18354 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18355 be processed than on other servers.
18356
18357 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18358 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18359 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18360 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18361 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18362 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18363 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18364 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18365 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18366 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18367 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18368 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18369 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18370
18371 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18372 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18373 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18374 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18375 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18376 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018377 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018378 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18379
18380 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18381 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18382 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18383 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18384 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18385 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018386 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018387 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18388 occurs.
18389
18390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183918.2.3. HTTP log format
18392----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018393
18394The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18395is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18396the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18397are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18398emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18399generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18400"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18401which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018402frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18403is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018404
18405Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18406slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18407with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18408
18409 Example :
18410 frontend http-in
18411 mode http
18412 option httplog
18413 log global
18414 default_backend bck
18415
18416 backend static
18417 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18418
18419 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18420 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18421 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018422 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018423
18424 Field Format Extract from the example above
18425 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18426 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018427 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018428 4 frontend_name http-in
18429 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018430 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018431 7 status_code 200
18432 8 bytes_read* 2750
18433 9 captured_request_cookie -
18434 10 captured_response_cookie -
18435 11 termination_state ----
18436 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18437 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18438 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18439 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18440 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018441
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018442Detailed fields description :
18443 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018444 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18445 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18446 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018447 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018448 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018449 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018450
18451 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018452 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18453 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18454 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018455
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018456 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18457 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018458
18459 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18460 and processed the connection.
18461
18462 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18463 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18464 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18465
18466 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18467 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18468 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18469 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18470 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18471 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18472
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018473 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18474 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18475 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018476 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018477 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18478 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018479 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18480 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018481
18482 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18483 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018484 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018485
18486 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18487 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018488 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18489 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018490
18491 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18492 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18493 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18494 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18495 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018496 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18497 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018498
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018499 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18500 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18501 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18502 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18503 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18504 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18505 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018506 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018507
18508 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18509 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18510 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18511
18512 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18513 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018514 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018515 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18516 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18517 overflowing.
18518
18519 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18520 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18521 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18522 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18523 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18524 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18525 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18526 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18527
18528 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18529 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18530 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18531 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18532 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18533 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18534 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18535 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18536
18537 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18538 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18539 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18540 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18541 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18542 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18543 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18544
18545 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018546 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018547 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18548 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18549 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018550 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018551 system.
18552
18553 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18554 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18555 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18556 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18557 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18558 caused by a denial of service attack.
18559
18560 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18561 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18562 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18563 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18564 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18565 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18566 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18567 denial of service attack.
18568
18569 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18570 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18571 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18572 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18573 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18574 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18575 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18576 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18577 processed than on other servers.
18578
18579 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18580 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18581 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18582 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18583 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18584 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18585 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18586 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18587 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18588 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18589 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18590 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18591 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18592
18593 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18594 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18595 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18596 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18597 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18598 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018599 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018600 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18601
18602 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18603 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18604 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18605 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18606 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18607 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018608 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018609 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18610 occurs.
18611
18612 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18613 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18614 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18615 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18616 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18617 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18618 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18619 cookies" below for more details.
18620
18621 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18622 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18623 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18624 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18625 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18626 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18627 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18628 and cookies" below for more details.
18629
18630 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18631 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18632 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18633 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18634 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18635 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18636 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18637 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18638
18639
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200186408.2.4. Custom log format
18641------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018642
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018643The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018644mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018645
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018646HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018647Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18648separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18649prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18650
18651Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18652variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018653("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018654
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018655If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018656as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018657less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18658the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18659
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018660Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018661In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018662in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018663
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018664Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18665'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18666https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18667such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18668
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018669Flags are :
18670 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018671 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018672 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18673 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018674
18675 Example:
18676
18677 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18678 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18679
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018680 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18681
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018682At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18683
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018684 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18685 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018686
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018687the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018688
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018689 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18690 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18691 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018692
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018693and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18694
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018695 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18696 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018697
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018698Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18699
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018700 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018701 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018702 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18703 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18704 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018705 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18706 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18707 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018708 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018709 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18710 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018711 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018712 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18713 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018714 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018715 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018716 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018717 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018718 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018719 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018720 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018721 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18722 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18723 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18724 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18725 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018726 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018727 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018728 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018729 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018730 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018731 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18732 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018733 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18734 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18735 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018736 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018737 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18738 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018739 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018740 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18741 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18742 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018743 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018744 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018745 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18746 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18747 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18748 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018749 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018750 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018751 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018752 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018753 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018754 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018755 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18756 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18757 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018758 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018759 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18760 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018761 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018762 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18763 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018764 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018765 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018766 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018767 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018768
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018769 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018770
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018771
187728.2.5. Error log format
18773-----------------------
18774
18775When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18776protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18777By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18778"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018779will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018780logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18781
18782The format looks like this :
18783
18784 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18785 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18786 Connection error during SSL handshake
18787
18788 Field Format Extract from the example above
18789 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18790 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18791 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18792 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18793 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18794
18795These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18796failures.
18797
18798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187998.3. Advanced logging options
18800-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018801
18802Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18803just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18804options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18805for more information about their usage.
18806
18807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188088.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18809------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018810
18811It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18812haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18813commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18814monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18815ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18816
18817 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18818 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18819 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18820 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18821
18822 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18823 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18824 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018825 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018826 such as other load-balancers.
18827
18828 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18829 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18830 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18831
18832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188338.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18834----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018835
18836The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18837what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18838or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018839"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018840just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18841log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18842after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18843is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18844with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18845with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18846
18847
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188488.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18849------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018850
18851Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18852for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18853"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18854retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18855raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18856a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18857file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18858you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18859"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18860
18861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188628.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18863--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018864
18865Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18866multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18867them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18868"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18869logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18870error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18871and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18872too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18873useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18874alternative.
18875
18876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188778.4. Timing events
18878------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018879
18880Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18881reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18882the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18883frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018884mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18885addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18886
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018887Timings events in HTTP mode:
18888
18889 first request 2nd request
18890 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18891 t tr t tr ...
18892 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18893 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18894 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18895 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018896 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018897 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18898
18899Timings events in TCP mode:
18900
18901 TCP session
18902 |<----------------->|
18903 t t
18904 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18905 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18906 |<------ Tt ------->|
18907
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018908 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018909 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018910 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18911 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18912 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018913 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018914 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18915 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18916 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18917 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018918
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018919 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18920 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18921 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018922 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18923 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18924 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18925 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18926 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18927 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018928
18929 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18930 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18931 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18932 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18933 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18934 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18935 request typed by hand during a test.
18936
18937 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18938 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018939 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018940 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18941 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18942 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18943 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018944
18945 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18946 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18947 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18948 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18949 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18950
18951 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18952 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18953 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18954 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18955 connection never established.
18956
18957 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18958 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18959 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18960 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18961 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18962 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18963 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18964 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18965 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18966 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18967 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18968
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018969 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18970 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18971 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18972 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18973 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18974 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18975
18976 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18977
18978 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18979 "Ta" can never be negative.
18980
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018981 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18982 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018983 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18984 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018985 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018986
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018987 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018988
18989 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018990 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18991 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018992
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018993 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
18994 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
18995 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
18996 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
18997 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
18998 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
18999 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19000 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19001
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019002These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19003protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19004that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019005due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19006"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19007that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019008
19009Most common cases :
19010
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019011 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19012 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19013 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19014 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19015 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19016 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19017 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19018 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19019 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19020 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19021 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019022 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019023
19024 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19025 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19026 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19027 of ms on remote networks.
19028
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019029 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19030 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19031 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019032
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019033 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19034 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19035 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19036 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19037 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19038 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19039 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19040 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19041 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019042
19043Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19044
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019045 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019046 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019047 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019048
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019049 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019050 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19051 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19052
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019053 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019054 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19055 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19056 flags.
19057
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019058 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19059 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019060 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19061 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19062 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19063 the client connection was maintained open.
19064
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019065 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019066 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019067 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019068 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19069
19070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190718.5. Session state at disconnection
19072-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019073
19074TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19075"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
190762-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19077each of which has a special meaning :
19078
19079 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19080 session to terminate :
19081
19082 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19083
19084 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19085 server explicitly refused it.
19086
19087 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19088 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19089 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19090 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019091 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019092
19093 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19094 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019095
19096 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19097 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19098 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19099 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19100 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19101
19102 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19103 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19104 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19105 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19106 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19107
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019108 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19109 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19110
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019111 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19112 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19113 backup connections when going up.
19114
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019115 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19116
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019117 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19118 send or receive data.
19119
19120 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19121 send or receive data.
19122
19123 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19124 with nothing left in the buffers.
19125
19126 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19127
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019128 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019129 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19130
19131 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19132 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19133 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19134 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19135 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19136
19137 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19138 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19139
19140 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19141 server (HTTP only).
19142
19143 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19144
19145 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19146 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19147 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19148
19149 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19150 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19151 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19152
19153 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19154
19155 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19156 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19157
19158 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19159 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19160 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19161
19162 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19163 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019164 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19165 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019166
19167 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19168 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19169 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19170 another server.
19171
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019172 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019173 server.
19174
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019175 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19176 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19177 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19178 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19179
19180 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19181 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19182 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19183 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19184
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019185 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19186 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19187 "use-server" rule).
19188
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019189 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19190
19191 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19192 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19193
19194 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19195
19196 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19197 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19198 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19199
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019200 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19201 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019202 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019203 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19204 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19205
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019206 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19207
19208 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19209 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19210
19211 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19212
19213 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19214
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019215The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19216was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019217helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19218starvation, attacks, etc...
19219
19220The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19221alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19222easier finding and understanding.
19223
19224 Flags Reason
19225
19226 -- Normal termination.
19227
19228 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19229 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19230 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19231 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19232
19233 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19234 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19235 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19236 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19237 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19238 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019239
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019240 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19241 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019242 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019243
19244 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19245 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19246 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19247
19248 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19249 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19250 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19251 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19252 the server takes too long to respond.
19253
19254 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19255 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19256 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19257 long a time to respond.
19258
19259 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19260 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19261 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19262 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019263 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19264 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019265
19266 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19267 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19268 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19269 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19270 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019271 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019272 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19273 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19274 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19275 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19276 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19277 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19278 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19279 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019280 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019281 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19282 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19283 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019284
19285 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19286 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019287 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19288 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19289 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19290 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019291
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019292 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19293 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019295 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019296 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19297 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019298 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019299 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19300 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19301
19302 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19303 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19304 503 or 504 here.
19305
19306 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19307 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19308 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19309 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19310 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19311
19312 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19313 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019314 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019315 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19316 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19317
19318 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19319 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19320 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19321 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19322 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19323 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19324 between haproxy and the server.
19325
19326 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19327 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19328 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19329 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19330 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19331 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19332 solution is to fix the application.
19333
19334 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19335 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19336 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19337 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19338 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19339 external attacks.
19340
19341 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19342 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019343 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019344 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19345 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19346
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019347 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19348 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19349 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019350 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019351 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019352
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019353 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19354 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19355 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19356 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019357 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19358 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19359 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19360 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19361 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019362
19363 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19364 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19365 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19366 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19367
19368 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19369 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19370 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19371 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19372
19373 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19374 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19375 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19376 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19377
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019378The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19379persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19380important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19381re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19382
19383 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19384
19385 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19386 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19387 set on a GET request.
19388
19389 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19390 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019391 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019392 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19393
19394 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19395 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19396 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19397
19398 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19399 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19400 already got a cookie.
19401
19402 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19403 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19404 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19405 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19406 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19407
19408 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19409 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19410 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19411
19412 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19413 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19414 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19415
19416 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19417 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19418
19419 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19420 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19421 then advertised in the response.
19422
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194248.6. Non-printable characters
19425-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019426
19427In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19428consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19429converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19430prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19431being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19432escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19433is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19434'}' when logging headers.
19435
19436Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19437issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19438containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19439
19440Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19441the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19442performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19443
19444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194458.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19446---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019447
19448Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19449achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019450section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019451cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19452the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19453the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019454locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019455not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19456user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19457a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19458wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19459
19460 Examples :
19461 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19462 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19463
19464 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19465 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19466
19467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194688.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19469---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019470
19471Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19472proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19473the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19474server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19475
19476Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19477response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019478section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019479
19480It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019481time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19482appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019483are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19484and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19485follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19486request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19487in the logs.
19488
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019489As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19490frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19491an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19492
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019493 Example :
19494 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19495 listen proxy-out
19496 mode http
19497 option httplog
19498 option logasap
19499 log global
19500 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19501
19502 # log the name of the virtual server
19503 capture request header Host len 20
19504
19505 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19506 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19507
19508 # log the beginning of the referrer
19509 capture request header Referer len 20
19510
19511 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19512 capture response header Server len 20
19513
19514 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19515 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19516
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019517 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019518 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19519
19520 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19521 capture response header Via len 20
19522
19523 # log the URL location during a redirection
19524 capture response header Location len 20
19525
19526 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19527 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19528 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19529 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19530 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19531
19532 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19533 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19534 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19535 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019536 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019537
19538 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19539 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19540 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19541 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19542 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019543 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019544
19545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195468.9. Examples of logs
19547---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019548
19549These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19550them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19551reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19552
19553 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19554 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19555 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19556
19557 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19558 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19559
19560 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19561 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19562 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19563
19564 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19565 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19566
19567 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19568 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19569 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19570
19571 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019572 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019573 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19574 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19575
19576 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19577 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19578 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19579
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019580 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19581 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19582 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19583 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19584 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19585 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019586
19587 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019588 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019589
19590 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19591 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19592 Nothing was sent to any server.
19593
19594 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19595 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19596
19597 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19598 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019599 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019600 send a 408 return code to the client.
19601
19602 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19603 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19604
19605 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19606 5 seconds ("c----").
19607
19608 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19609 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019610 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019611
19612 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019613 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019614 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19615 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19616 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19617 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19618 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019619
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019620
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200196219. Supported filters
19622--------------------
19623
19624Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19625accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19626unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19627
19628See also : "filter"
19629
196309.1. Trace
19631----------
19632
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019633filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019634
19635 Arguments:
19636 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19637 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19638
19639 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19640 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19641 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19642 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19643
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019644 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019645 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19646 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19647 amount of the parsed data.
19648
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019649 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019650
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019651This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19652callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19653information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19654filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19655
19656Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19657tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19658a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19659
19660
196619.2. HTTP compression
19662---------------------
19663
19664filter compression
19665
19666The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19667keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019668when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19669fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19670done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19671explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19672filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19673listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19674order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019675
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019676See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19677 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019678
19679
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200196809.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19681--------------------------------------------
19682
19683filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19684
19685 Arguments :
19686
19687 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19688 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19689 parsed.
19690
19691 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19692 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19693 part must be placed in its own scope.
19694
19695The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19696external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019697streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019698exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19699also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19700
19701SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19702the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19703
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019704For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019705"doc/SPOE.txt".
19706
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100197079.4. Cache
19708----------
19709
19710filter cache <name>
19711
19712 Arguments :
19713
19714 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19715
19716The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19717"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019718cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019719other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19720case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19721is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19722filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019723listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19724order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019725
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019726See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19727 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19728
19729
197309.5. Fcgi-app
19731-------------
19732
19733filter fcg-app <name>
19734
19735 Arguments :
19736
19737 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19738
19739The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19740request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19741reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19742used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19743implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19744used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19745fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19746used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19747order.
19748
19749See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19750 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19751
19752
1975310. FastCGI applications
19754-------------------------
19755
19756HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19757feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19758the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19759FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19760servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19761FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19762backend.
19763
19764HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19765application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19766connection.
19767
1976810.1. Setup
19769-----------
19770
1977110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19772--------------------------
19773
19774fcgi-app <name>
19775 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19776 document root must be defined.
19777
19778acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19779 Declare or complete an access list.
19780
19781 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19782 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19783 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19784 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19785 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19786
19787docroot <path>
19788 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19789 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19790 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19791
19792index <script-name>
19793 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19794 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19795 is an optional setting.
19796
19797 Example :
19798 index index.php
19799
19800log-stderr global
19801log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19802 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19803 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19804
19805 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19806 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19807
19808pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19809 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19810 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19811 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19812
19813 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19814 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19815 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19816 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19817
19818 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19819 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19820
19821path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019822 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019823 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19824 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19825 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19826 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19827 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19828 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19829 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019830
19831 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019832 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019833 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19834 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19835 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19836 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019837
19838 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019839 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19840 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019841
19842option get-values
19843no option get-values
19844 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19845
19846 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19847 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19848
19849 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19850 application will accept.
19851
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019852 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19853 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019854
19855 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19856 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19857 option is disabled.
19858
19859 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19860 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19861 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19862 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19863 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19864 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19865
19866option keep-conn
19867no option keep-conn
19868 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19869 sending a response.
19870
19871 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19872 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19873
19874option max-reqs <reqs>
19875 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19876 accept.
19877
19878 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19879 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19880 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19881 to 1.
19882
19883option mpxs-conns
19884no option mpxs-conns
19885 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19886
19887 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19888 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19889
19890set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19891 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19892 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19893 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19894 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19895
19896 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19897 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19898 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19899
19900 Example :
19901 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19902 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19903
19904 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19905
19906
1990710.1.2. Proxy section
19908---------------------
19909
19910use-fcgi-app <name>
19911 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19912
19913 Arguments :
19914 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19915
19916 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19917 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19918 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19919 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19920 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19921
19922 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19923 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19924 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19925 application are evaluated.
19926
19927
1992810.1.3. Example
19929---------------
19930
19931 frontend front-http
19932 mode http
19933 bind *:80
19934 bind *:
19935
19936 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19937 default_backend back-static
19938
19939 backend back-static
19940 mode http
19941 server www A.B.C.D:80
19942
19943 backend back-dynamic
19944 mode http
19945 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19946 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19947
19948 fcgi-app php-fpm
19949 log-stderr global
19950 option keep-conn
19951
19952 docroot /var/www/my-app
19953 index index.php
19954 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19955
19956
1995710.2. Default parameters
19958------------------------
19959
19960A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19961the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019962script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019963applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19964
19965 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19966 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19967 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19968 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19969 | | |
19970 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19971 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19972 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19973 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19974 | | application. |
19975 | | |
19976 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19977 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19978 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19979 | | |
19980 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19981 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19982 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19983 | | the application's configuration. |
19984 | | |
19985 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19986 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19987 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19988 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19989 | | |
19990 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19991 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19992 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19993 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19994 | | be defined. |
19995 | | |
19996 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19997 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19998 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19999 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20000 | | is not set too. |
20001 | | |
20002 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20003 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20004 | | set. |
20005 | | |
20006 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20007 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20008 | | the request. |
20009 | | |
20010 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20011 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20012 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20013 | | |
20014 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20015 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20016 | | script to process the request. |
20017 | | |
20018 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20019 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20020 | | |
20021 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20022 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20023 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20024 | | |
20025 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20026 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20027 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20028 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20029 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20030 | | |
20031 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20032 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20033 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20034 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20035 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20036 | | side. |
20037 | | |
20038 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20039 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20040 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20041 | | connected to. |
20042 | | |
20043 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20044 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20045 | | |
20046 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20047 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20048 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20049 | | |
20050 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20051
20052
2005310.3. Limitations
20054------------------
20055
20056The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20057way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20058during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20059establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20060application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20061or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20062message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20063these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20064and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20065
20066Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20067request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20068requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20069
20070About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20071into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20072fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20073"http-request" ones.
20074
20075Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20076FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20077processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20078must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20079here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020080
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020081/*
20082 * Local variables:
20083 * fill-column: 79
20084 * End:
20085 */